2019 59 2 ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA GEOGRAFSKI ZBORNIK 59-2 2019 ZNANSTVENORAZISKOVALNI CENTER SLOVENSKE AKADEMIJE ZNANOSTI IN UMETNOSTI GEOGRAFSKI INŠTITUT ANTONA MELIKA • RESEARCH CENTRE OF THE SLOVENIAN ACADEMY OF SCIENCES AND ARTS ANTON MELIK GEOGRAPHICAL INSTITUTE ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA GEOGRAFSKI ZBORNIK 59-2 2019 ZALOŽBA Z R C ^IMIPUO LJUBLJANA 2019 ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA ISSN: 1581-6613 COBISS: 124775936 UDC/UDK: 91 © 2019, ZRC SAZU, Geografski inštitut Antona Melika International editorial board/mednarodni uredniški odbor: David Bole (Slovenia), Michael Bründl (Switzerland), Rok Ciglič (Slovenia), Matej Gabrovec (Slovenia), Matjaž Geršič (Slovenia), Peter Jordan (Austria), Drago Kladnik (Slovenia), Blaž Komac (Slovenia), Andrej Kranjc (Slovenia), Dénes Lóczy (Hungary), Simon McCharty (United Kingdom), Slobodan Markovic (Serbia), Janez Nared (Slovenia), Drago Perko (Slovenia), Marjan Ravbar (Slovenia), Nika Razpotnik Viskovic (Slovenia), Aleš Smrekar (Slovenia), Annett Steinführer (Germany), Mimi Urbanc (Slovenia), Matija Zorn (Slovenia) Editor-in-Chief/glavni urednik: Blaž Komac; blaz@zrc-sazu.si Executive editor/odgovorni urednik: Drago Perko; drago@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for physical geography/glavni urednik za fizično geografijo: Matija Zorn; matija.zorn@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for human geography/glavna urednica za humano geografijo: Mimi Urbanc; mimi@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for regional geography/glavni urednik za regionalno geografijo: Drago Kladnik; drago.kladnik@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for spatial planning/glavni urednik za regionalno planiranje: Janez Nared; janez.nared@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for rural geography/glavna urednica za geografijo podeželja: Nika Razpotnik Viskovic; nika.razpotnik@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for urban geography/glavni urednik za urbano geografijo: David Bole; david.bole@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for geographic information systems/glavni urednik za geografske informacijske sisteme: Rok Ciglič; rok.ciglic@zrc-sazu.si Chief editor for environmental protection/glavni urednik za varstvo okolja: Aleš Smrekar; ales.smrekar@zrc-sazu.si Editorial assistant/uredniškipomočnik: Matjaž Geršič; matjaz.gersic@zrc-sazu.si Issued by/izdajatelj: Geografski inštitut Antona Melika ZRC SAZU Published by/založnik: Založba ZRC Co-published by/sozaložnik: Slovenska akademija znanosti in umetnosti Address/Naslov: Geografski inštitut Antona Melika ZRC SAZU, Gosposka ulica 13, SI - 1000 Ljubljana, Slovenija The papers are available on-line/prispevki so dostopni na medmrežju: http://ags.zrc-sazu.si (ISSN: 1581-8314) Ordering/naročanje: Založba ZRC, Novi trg 2, p. p. 306, SI - 1001 Ljubljana, Slovenija; zalozba@zrc-sazu.si Annual subscription/letna naročnina: 20 € for individuals/za posameznike, 28 € for institutions/za ustanove. Single issue/cenaposamezne številke: 12,50 € for individuals/za posameznike, 16 € for institutions/za ustanove. Cartography/kartografija: Geografski inštitut Antona Melika ZRC SAZU Translations/prevodi: DEKS, d. o. o. DTP/prelom: SYNCOMP, d. o. o. Printed by/tiskarna: Tiskarna Present, d. o. o. Print run/naklada: 450 copies/izvodov The journal is subsidized by the Slovenian Research Agency and is issued in the framework of the Geography of Slovenia core research programme (P6-0101)/revija izhaja s podporo Javne agencije za raziskovalno dejavnost Republike Slovenije in nastaja v okviru raziskovalnega programa Geografija Slovenije (P6-0101). The journal is indexed also in/revija je vključena tudi v: SCIE - Science Citation Index Expanded, Scopus, JCR - Journal Citation Report/Science Edition, ERIH PLUS, GEOBASE Journals, Current geographical publications, EBSCOhost, Geoscience e-Journals, Georef, FRANCIS, SJR (SCImago Journal & Country Rank), OCLC WorldCat, Google scholar, and CrossRef. Oblikovanje/Design by: Matjaž Vipotnik Front cover photography: Exploration of the collapse dolines, such as the one at the Small Natural Bridge in Rakov Škocjan, has enabled a deeper understanding of karst processes in recent years (photograph: Matej Lipar). Fotografija na naslovnici: Raziskave udornice, kot je ta pri Malem Naravnem mostu v Rakovem Škocjanu, so v zadnjih letih omogočile globlje razumevanje kraških procesov (fotografija: Matej Lipar). ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA ISSN: 1581-6613 UDC: 91 Number: 59-2 Year: 2019 Contents Drago PERKO, Rok CIGLIC, Mauro HRVATIN The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification: The case of Slovenia 7 Vladimir M. CVETKOVIC, Kevin RONAN, Rajib SHAW, Marina FILIPOVIC, Rita MANO, Jasmina GACIC, Vladimir JAKOVLJEVIC Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities 27 Iwona CIESLAK Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use 43 Ivan PAUNOVIC, Verka JOVANOVIC Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro regions of the Alps and the Dinarides 59 Nikola Darko VUKSANOVIC, Dragan TESANOVIC, Bojana KALENJUK, Milijanko PORTIC Gender, age and education differences in food consumption within a region: Case studies of Belgrade and Novi Sad (Serbia) 71 Special issue - Franciscean cadaster as a source of studying landscape changes Matej GABROVEC, Ivan BIČiK, Blaž KOMAC Land registers as a source of studying long-term land-use changes 83 Ivan BIČiK, Matej GABROVEC, Lucie KUPKOVA Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia 91 5 Lucie KUPKOVA, Ivan BICiK, Zdenek BOUDNY Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions 107 Drago KLADNIK, Matjaž GERŠIČ, Primož PIPAN, Manca VOLK BAHUN Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes 119 Daniela RIBEIRO, Mateja ŠMID HRIBAR Assessment of land-use changes and their impacts on ecosystem services in two Slovenian rural landscapes 143 Mojca FOŠKI, Alma ZAVODNIK LAMOVŠEK Monitoring land-use change using selected indices 161 6 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 7-42 THE USEFULNESS OF UNSUPERVISED CLASSIFICATION METHODS FOR LANDSCAPE TYPIFICATION: THE CASE OF SLOVENIA Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin The landscape classification of countries with a high landscape diversity, such as Slovenia, using a computer and various classification methods is a difficult task. The picture shows three landscape types: fertile flysch Mediterranean hills with the Bay of Koper (foreground), Mediterranean karst plateaus (middle), and high Dinaric karst plateaus (background). Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.7377 UDC: 911.5(497.4) COBISS: 1.01 The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification: The case of Slovenia ABSTRACT: Supervised and unsupervised classification methods can be a useful tool in determining various geographical spatial divisions, especially regionalizations and typifications. Because Slovenia is geographically very diverse, its divisions are a particularly significant and interesting research challenge. The main objective of this article is to determine the effectiveness of unsupervised classification methods, and therefore we compare the well-established landscape typology of Slovenia from 1996 with landscape typologies that were modeled using various unsupervised classification methods. Our results show that landscape typologies modeled using unsupervised classification methods deviate more from the original landscape typology of Slovenia than landscape typologies modeled using random and expert-supervised classification methods. KEY WORDS: geography, geographic information system, modeling, classification, landscape typology, Slovenia Uporabnost metod nenadzorovane klasifikacije za pokrajinsko tipizacijo na primeru Slovenije POVZETEK: Metode nadzorovane in nenadzorovane klasifikacije so lahko koristno orodje pri določanju različnih geografskih prostorskih delitev, še posebej pri regionalizacijah in tipizacijah. Ker je Slovenija geografsko zelo raznolika, so njene delitve še posebej velik in zanimiv raziskovalni izziv. Glavni namen članka je ugotoviti učinkovitost metod nenadzorovane klasifikacije, zato primerjamo uveljavljeno pokrajinsko tipizacijo Slovenije iz leta 1996 s pokrajinskimi tipizacijami, ki smo jih modelirali z različnimi metodami nenadzorovane klasifikacije. Naši rezultati kažejo, da se pokrajinske tipizacije, modelirane z metodami nenadzorovane klasifikacije, izvirni pokrajinski tipizaciji Slovenije ne približajo tako dobro, kot pokrajinske tipizacije, modelirane z metodami naključne in ekspertne nadzorovane klasifikacije. KLJUČNE BESEDE: geografija, geografski informacijski sistem, modeliranje, klasifikacija, pokrajinska tipizacija, Slovenija Drago Perko, Rok Ciglič, Mauro Hrvatin Research Center of the Slovenian Academy of Sciences and Arts, Anton Melik Geographical Institute drago@zrc-sazu.si, rok.ciglic@zrc-sazu.si, mauro@zrc-sazu.si This article was submitted for publication on February 26th, 2018. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 26. februarja 2018 8 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction Regionalizations and typifications are among the most complicated fields of research in geography (Hammond 1964; Dikau, Brabb and Mark 1991; Kladnik 1996; Brabyn 1998; McMahon, Wiken and Gauthier 2004; Gallant, Douglas and Hoffer 2005; Iwahashi and Pike 2006; Ellison 2010; Ciglič 2014). This is especially the case with the spatial divisions of Slovenia, which despite being a small country has some of the most diverse landscapes in the world (Melik 1935; Ilešič 1956; 1958; Gams 1983; Natek 1993; Gams, Kladnik and Orožen Adamič 1995; Gabrovec and Hrvatin 1998; Gams 1998; Perko 1998; Plut 1999; Špes et al. 2002; Kladnik, Perko and Urbanc 2009; Perko and Hrvatin 2009; Hrvatin and Perko 2012; Ciglič and Perko 2012; 2013). This is most likely why Slovenian geographers have only produced four true landscape typologies to date. The first one, which included eighteen landscape types, was produced by Anton Melik in 1946 (Melik 1946), the second was produced by Drago Perko in 1996 and included nine landscape types (Kladnik 1996; Perko 1998; Perko 2001; Perko 2007), the third one, produced in 2002 by Metka Špes et al., contained thirteen types (Špes et al. 2002), and the fourth was produced in 2014 by Drago Perko et al. and included twenty-four landscape types (Perko, Hrvatin and Ciglič 2015). Through increasingly more precise and accessible digital spatial data, technological development has also introduced changes to geographical classifications, including regionalization and typification, with various models and geographic information systems becoming widely used and influential research methods (Demeritt and Wainwright 2005). The term classification has several definitions (McGarigal, Cushman and Stafford 2000). Thus, for example, it can refer to any formal arrangement of data into a hierarchy of categories or distribution into classes (Whittow 2000), or systematic assignment to classes or groups based on shared characteristics (Clark 1998). Classifications can be roughly divided into supervised and unsupervised classifications. To date, Slovenian geographers have primarily modeled supervised classifications and compared them against the 1996 landscape typology of Slovenia, which comprises nine types combined into four groups and is most widely used and also included in Slovenian legislation. Landscape typology models were produced using various supervised classification methods based on the training samples of already classified or defined cells of individual landscape types. It was determined that the method selection had a strong impact on the results because modeled typologies matched the original ones by 51 to 75% (Ciglič 2014; Ciglič and Perko 2015). During the last testing of the original 1996 typology, its accuracy was estimated at 94% (Ciglič et al. 2017). The capacity and impact of methods were also determined using distorted classifications (Ciglič 2018), which allowed for additional evaluations of the original classification. However, for the first time in Slovenian research history, this article deals with models of Slovenia's landscape typologies based on unsupervised classification methods and contain the same number of types (groups) as the original 1996 landscape typology. Unsupervised models are compared against the original typology and supervised models, which contributes to evaluating supervised and unsupervised classification methods as well as assessing the suitability of the original typology's concept and design. With regard to unsupervised classification, it is important to know that the characteristics of individual types (i.e., groups) are not known in advance, but that unsupervised classification methods define or identify them by themselves. 2 The importance of landscape classification There is still no agreement on whether landscape classification entails searching for actual or merely abstract units (Gams 1984; Udo de Haes and Klijn 1994; Bailey 1996), but, in any case, a classification is a minor or major abstraction of differences between features (Natek and Žiberna 2004). It is natural for people to seek order and organization among phenomena (Haggett 2001), which also applies to spatial or landscape phenomena. Because landscapes constantly change, constant verification of landscape types is essential (Mucher et al. 2003), facilitating more economical use of natural resources and their replenishment. Landscape changes must be accompanied by ongoing adaptation of society's organization and operation to the environment (Plut 2005), which makes it possible to implement principles of sustainability in the economy, society, and environment. Landscape types are important because they relatively homogenously respond to human impact (Špes et al. 2002) and demand similar landscape planning. 9 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... Spatial classification following the natural characteristics of a landscape forms the basis for optimal spatial organization. Environmental issues also relate more to natural borders than administrative ones (Bailey 1996; Olson et al. 2001), which is why spatial classifications based on natural factors are becoming increasingly common and are replacing political classifications (Bernert et al. 1997). For instance, NUTS3 regions, which in the Mediterranean often include rural and urban coastal areas (Hazeu et al. 2011), may vary greatly in terms of their natural and social characteristics. Various disciplines use classifications adapted to the content of their research and their needs (e.g., climate, vegetation, and soil classifications), but often their work would be made easier through uniform landscape classifications (Brabyn 2018), especially at different spatial levels (McMahon, Wiken and Gauthier 2004). A landscape classification at the highest spatial level can be used to outline borders for general purposes and various disciplines, whereas spatial units or landscape types at a lower level can serve as a starting point for more specific purposes (Bailey 1996) or classification within individual disciplines. This requires understanding of the relations between a landscape as a whole and its components (e.g., land use and biodiversity), which is vital for managing the environment (landscape) and its resources (Jongman et al. 2006). Landscape classification is also important for preserving the natural and cultural landscape; inventorying, evaluating, and monitoring the current situation; managing, planning, and conducting measurements; exploring scenarios; sampling; transferring models into the physical environment; presenting landscape diversity; analyzing environmental pressures; and so on (Runhaar and Udo de Haes 1994; Bailey 1996; Bunce et al. 1996; Bernert et al.1997; Bastian 2000; Mucher et al. 2003; Loveland and Merchant 2004; Romportl and Chuman 2012). Based on all the above, it is not surprising that in some places classifications even have a formal character, being part of official documents or even legislation in specific countries. In 1996, the EU introduced the Pan-European Biological and Landscape Diversity Strategy (Pan-European... 1996), and in 2000 it adopted the European Landscape Convention (The European ... 2018). For example, in Slovenia the landscape typology of the country (Perko 1998) is used in defining land quality assessment criteria (Pravilnik o določanju... 2008). 3 Classification methods Classification entails combining similar units based on logical criteria (Dodge 2008). As part of geographic information systems, units are defined with p data layers or, in other words, they have p dimensions. Classifications can be made based on a single criterion or factor (a monothetic approach) or several factors (a polythetic approach). The former involves a one-dimensional and the latter a multidimensional data space (Loveland and Merchant 2004). Many classification methods are used (McGarigal, Cushman and Stafford 2000; Rogerson 2006; Abonyi and Feil 2007; Dodge 2008; Warner and Campagna 2009) and, in terms of results, each of them more or less imposes a specific structure and leads to a specific solution. Therefore, it is best to compare the results of various methods (Ferligoj 1989; McGarigal, Cushman and Stafford 2000; Theodoridis and Koutroumbas 2006; Ciglič 2018). Classification methods are divided into soft and hard or relative and absolute, but most often a distinction is made between supervised and unsupervised classifications (Warner and Campagna 2009). With supervised methods, known values of training cells are available for classification, whereas that is not the case with unsupervised ones (Theodoridis and Koutroumbas 2006); both are, however, at least partially shaped by an individual's subjective judgment and knowledge (Warner and Campagna 2009). As part of supervised classification, specific examples of units are selected from individual groups, which should have the most typical values possible, and based on these examples rules are designed for assigning all the remaining units to the types defined in advance. In contrast, as part of unsupervised classification, units can be categorized based on their characteristics or values even without any prior information about the units (Ferligoj 1989; Oštir 2006), which is a certain advantage compared to supervised classifications. The aim of unsupervised classification in groups is to achieve the maximum internal homogeneity and the minimum external isolation of groups (Ferligoj 1989) or to minimize variance within the group and maximize variance between groups (Rogerson 2006). 10 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Unsupervised classification methods have several weaknesses (McGarigal, Cushman and Stafford 2000), such as sensitivity to outliers, which these methods often assign to a separate class, and great dependency of results on the initial groups defined and their number. The unsupervised classification procedure can be divided into five basic steps (Ferligoj 1989; Theodoridis and Koutroumbas 2006): • Step 1: selecting the units; • Step 2: selecting the variables; • Step 3: computing the similarities (and differences) between units; • Step 4: selecting and carrying out the classification method; and • Step 5: assessing the final classification, which can only be done by an expert in the relevant field. Various relatively detailed digital data on natural geographical factors are available for Slovenia (Ciglic et al. 2016). Among these, over forty variables or data layers were selected and then normalized to values from 0 to 100, and adjusted to a uniform resolution of 200 m (the resolution of the least accurate layer), which means that Slovenia was divided into 506,450 units or cells. This completed the step 1 (selecting the units). Step 2 entailed an assessment of all data layers in terms of their usefulness for landscape typology modeling (Ciglic 2012, 2013, 2014; Ciglic and Perko 2017). The following three criteria were applied: correlation between data layers, correlation between data layers and available landscape typologies, and suitability of data layers in terms of the classification level or scale (the scales were determined at which an individual data layer was still sufficiently diverse to be suitable for classification). Eliminating less important data layers can reduce the time and costs of implementation, while also simplifying the understanding of modeling procedures (Jiang et al. 2008; Tirelli and Passani 2011). Based on the criteria mentioned above, the following four data layers were selected for landscape typology modeling: elevation, slope, rock permeability, and precipitation regime (the ratio between summer and fall precipitation). Steps 3 and 4 already depend on the individual methods selected. Several unsupervised classification methods and their versions and settings in various software were tested for modeling the typologies of Slovenia. Four methods from the TerrSet software (the former Idrisi) were selected for presentation in this article: the histogram peak analysis method, the iterative self-organizing unsupervised classifier method, the k-means method, and the iterative self-organizing data analysis method. 3.1 Histogram peak analysis The histogram peak analysis method is based on frequency distribution and classifies cells in groups using a multidimensional histogram (Richards and Jia 2006). It first looks for peaks in a multidimensional histogram (i.e., the values with the highest frequency) and then assigns every cell to its nearest peak, forming groups. The areas between the peaks (i.e., valleys) have values with the lowest frequency, creating boundaries between groups (Eastman 2016). In the TerrSet program, this method is available as part of the CLUSTER module (TerrSet... 2015), in which the user can set the following parameters: number of data layers, number of classes for each data layer or gray levels, cutoffs for excluding extreme values or the saturation percentage, generalization level (broad or fine) for identifying peaks, and clustering rule, through which the user can drop less significant clusters, set the maximum number of clusters, or retain all clusters. The following settings were selected: gray levels = 6, saturation percentage =1%, generalization level = fine, and clustering rule = maximum nine groups. 3.2 The iterative self-organizing unsupervised classifier method In TerrSet, the iterative self-organizing unsupervised classifier method is available as part of the ISOCLUST module (TerrSet... 2015), which in fact uses three other modules for this method. With the CLUSTER module it first derives the initial clusters (or seeds) using a multidimensional histogram (like with the histogram peak analysis; see Section 3.1), after which it employs the modules MAKESIG and MAXLIKE to 11 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... automatically define the training sites and perform a supervised classification. It repeats the procedure several times using new training cells from individual clusters. Because of the efficiency of the seeding step, very few iterations are usually required to achieve a stable cluster. The user first selects the data layers and then specifies the number of iterations, the desired number of clusters, and the minimum sample size per class. The following settings were selected: number of iterations = 99, number of clusters desired = 9, and minimum sample size per class = 40. 3.3 K-means Classification following the k-means method is based on distances between cells in multidimensional space. The final classification strongly depends on the definition of the number of clusters (k) and the initialization of centroids (centers) - that is, central cells around which other cells gather. First, the user specifies the number of clusters and the methods (rules) for initializing the cluster centroids, after which new, more appropriate centroids are calculated. This procedure is repeated until the new centroids are the same as the centroids from the previous iteration (Ferligoj 1989; Richards and Jia 2006). Initial centroids can also be selected randomly or dispersed evenly between cells (Ferligoj 1989). In TerrSet, this method is available as part of the KMEANS module (TerrSet... 2015), in which different rules for initializing the centroids can be selected: • The random partition rule randomly assigns each cell to one of the k clusters and then determines the initial centroids; • The random seed rule randomly selects k cells as the initial centroids and then assigns each cell to one of the k clusters according to the minimum-distance rule; and • The diagonal axis rule systematically sorts k centroids from the «-dimensional space from the minimum to the maximum value of n data layers. In addition to specifying the rule for initializing the cluster centroids, the user selects the maximum number of output clusters and the option to merge (overly) small clusters, which do not exceed the selected percentage of the entire image cells, with larger ones. The user also specifies two stopping criteria to terminate the clustering process. With the first one, the process is terminated if during the last iteration the percentage of migrating cells is less than a specified percentage of all cells, and, with the second criterion, the process stops when a specified number of iterations has been reached. The following settings were selected for this study: maximum number of output clusters = 9, cluster cen-troid initialization rule = random seed, merge clusters with proportions less than or equal to 1%, and stopping criteria = percentage of migration cells (pixels) less than or equal to 1% and maximum iterations 999. 3.4 Iterative self-organizing data analysis The iterative self-organizing data analysis (ISODATA) is an improved k-means method. It can merge clusters, just like the k-means technique, but it can also split them. It determines the initial centroids and clusters the same way as the k-means method, after which it calculates the standard deviation within each cluster and the distances between cluster centroids. It splits a cluster into two if the standard deviation is higher than the one specified by the user, or it merges two clusters if the distance between two cluster centroids is smaller than the one specified by the user. It repeats the process with new clusters and new centroids. The process is terminated if the standard deviation and distances between centroids no longer make it possible to merge or split clusters, if during the last iteration the percentage of migrating pixels is less than that specified by the user or if the process reaches the number of iterations specified. In TerrSet, this method is available as part of the ISODATA module (TerrSet... 2015). The following settings were specified for this study: initial number of clusters = 9, maximum number of output clusters = 9, cluster centroid initialization rule = random seed, stopping criteria = percentage of migration cells (pixels) less than or equal to 1% and maximum iterations 999, minimum cluster size = 100, standard deviation within a cluster for splitting = 25, Euclidean distance between clusters for merging = 12.5, and maximum number of pairs to merge within an iteration = 2. 12 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Figure 1: CLUSTER, ISOCLUST, KMEANS, and ISODATA modules in the TerrSet program. 4 Landscape typology modeling using unsupervised classification methods Each of the four methods presented was used to produce typologies with various numbers of classes. This article describes in detail modeled landscape typologies with nine classes, which were compared against the best-established landscape typology of Slovenia of 1996, which contains nine landscape types combined into four landscape type groups. 13 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... The process of creating the 1996 landscape typology started in 1995. Perko (1998) entered the following four data layers into the geographic information system: surface elevation, surface inclination, lithology, and vegetation types. The inclination and elevation data were based on a 100 m digital elevation model, and the lithology and vegetation data were obtained through digitization of a 1:250,000 lithological map with thirty-seven basic units (Verbič 1998) and a vegetation map with sixty-two basic units (Zupančič et al. 1998) converted to a 100 m raster grid. All four layers were then generalized and simplified into seven classes. Perko overlaid (intersected) all four layers. Altogether 2,401 different combinations were theoretically possible. Perko filtered the intersected layer three times using the modus inside of a moving 11x11 cell square window, obtaining forty-eight larger and spatially separate homogenous cores with the same combination of elevation, inclination, lithology, and vegetation. He printed the cores on a 1:250,000 map and, with the help of experts for individual parts of Slovenia, manually plotted the boundaries, mostly in morphological boundaries and larger watercourses. In the end, he combined these forty-eight manually delineated landscape units into nine landscape types, which he merged further into four landscape type groups. The nine landscape types are: Alpine mountains, Alpine hills, Alpine plains, Pannonian low hills, Pannonian plains, Dinaric plateaus, Dinaric lowlands, Mediterranean low hills, and Mediterranean plateaus. The four landscape type groups are Alpine landscapes, Pannonian landscapes, Dinaric landscapes, and Mediterranean landscapes. This was the first partly computerized typology of Slovenia. Its research bases were first presented in 1998 (Perko 1998). It has been published in all major geographical works on Slovenia issued after Slovenia's independence. Since 2008, it has also been part of Slovenian tax legislation and has been used for rating agricultural land according to the Rules on Determining and Administering Land Rating. As already described in Chapter 3 the CLUSTER, ISOCLUST, KMEANS, and ISODATA modules in the TerrSet software were used for modeling. The modeled typologies were compared against the original 1996 typology in terms of the correlation coefficient between the modeled typologies and the original typology, the cluster density in the modeled typologies by landscape type of the original typology, and the ratio between the actual and theoretical cluster frequency in the modeled typologies by landscape type of the original typology. The first indicator was cluster density by landscape type of the original typology - that is, the number of cells in an individual cluster per 100 cells of a specific landscape type. The maximum value of density possible is 100, which is when all the cells of an individual cluster lie within a specific landscape type, and the minimum value is 0, when a specific landscape type does not contain even a single cell of this cluster. If the cells of all nine clusters were evenly distributed across the nine landscape types of the original typology in the modeled typologies, the density of all clusters would be 11. A cluster with a density of at least twice as much (i.e., at least 22) was defined as a typical representative of this landscape type. If a modeled typology was completely the same as the original typology, each of the nine clusters would have a density of 100 in only one landscape type, whereas the density in the remaining eight landscape types would be 0. If, for instance, Cluster 7 of a modeled typology had thirty-three cells per one hundred cells of Dinaric plateaus, Cluster 7 would be a good representative or approximation of the Dinaric plateaus in the original typology. The indicator ratio between the actual and theoretical cluster frequency in the modeled typologies by landscape type of the original typology relies on contingency tables, in which the rows and columns represent clusters and landscape types, and the cells contain the actual frequency (number) of cells in individual clusters by individual landscape type. Clusters that had their actual frequency in a specific landscape type at least twice the theoretical frequency were defined as typical representatives of this landscape type. For example, in Table 1, at the intersection of Cluster 9, which was specified using the ISODATA method, and the Alpine mountains landscape type the actual frequency - that is, the number of cells of Cluster 9 that lie within the Alpine mountains (their total is 27,975) - is provided. The theoretical frequency of that table cell is 4,811 and equals the total of all cells of Cluster 9 in the last column (31,835) and all cells of the Alpine mountains in the last row (76,533) divided by the number of all cells (506,450). Because the ratio between the actual and theoretical frequency (5.82) is greater than 2, Cluster 9 is a good representative of the Alpine mountains. The correlation coefficient between the modeled typologies and the original typology also relies on contingency tables. Cramer's V was selected for the study; it has lower values than the Pearson correlation coefficient, but it does not depend on the size of the tables and therefore allows comparisons between tables with different numbers of columns and rows or between typologies with different numbers of classes. 14 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Table 1: Example of arranging cells of a nine-cluster typology modeled using the ISODATA module by nine landscape types of the original typology. ISODATA module Alpine mountains Alpine hills Alpine plains Pannonian low hills Pannonian plains Dinaric plateaus Dinaric lowlands Mediterranean low hills Mediterranean plateaus Total Cluster 1 5,288 34,123 2,382 31,609 1,264 3,747 5,448 0 0 83,861 Cluster 2 250 6,543 2,435 30,360 25,360 0 0 0 0 64,948 Cluster 3 5,762 29,497 143 593 11 78 88 0 0 36,172 Cluster 4 8,365 1,395 224 0 0 33,590 9,724 5,654 13,885 72,837 Cluster 5 4,516 10,161 888 0 0 12,956 6,570 18,477 2,738 56,306 Cluster 6 14,932 8,997 115 5 0 11,493 366 663 183 36,754 Cluster 7 2,379 4,470 13,832 3,349 5,545 20,106 20,861 1,681 27 72,250 Cluster 8 7,066 20,840 447 8,803 156 9,845 4,330 0 0 51,487 Cluster 9 27,975 452 15 0 0 3,375 0 15 3 31,835 Total 76,533 116,478 20,481 74,719 32,336 95,190 47,387 26,490 16,836 506,450 4.1 Modeling using nine clusters A graphic presentation of cluster distribution according to the four selected unsupervised classification methods using nine clusters is provided in Figure 2. The original typology with nine landscape types and the original typology with four landscape type groups are added for comparison. The correlation coefficients between the original classification and the classifications produced using the four modules presented above are as follows: 0.4489 for the CLUSTER classification, 0.4159 for the ISOCLUST classification (the lowest among all four classifications), 0.4609 for the KMEANS classification (the highest among all classifications), and 0.4518 for the ISODATA classification. The density of cells in an individual cluster by nine landscape types (Table 2) shows how well the clusters spatially match the landscape types. Clusters with a density of 22 or more are good representatives or approximations of a specific landscape type. In the CLUSTER classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation of the Alpine hills and the Pannonian low hills, Cluster 2 is a good approximation of the Alpine plains, Pannonian plains, Pannonian low hills, and Dinaric lowlands, Cluster 3 of the Alpine mountains and Dinaric plateaus, Cluster 5 of the Pannonian plains, and Clusters 6 and 9 of the Mediterranean low hills and Mediterranean plateaus, whereas Clusters 4, 7, and 8 are not a good approximation of even a single landscape type. Cluster 4 demonstrates the highest cell density (18) in the Alpine hills, Cluster 7 in the Alpine mountains (18), and Cluster 8 in the Dinaric plateaus (15). Thus, Cluster 1 has a density over 22 in two landscape types, Cluster 2 in four types, Cluster 3 in two types, Cluster 5 in one type, and both Clusters 6 and 9 in two types. All landscape types are represented: five types in one cluster and four types in two clusters, which means that these clusters are a good spatial match with two landscape types, not just one. In the ISOCLUST classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation of the Alpine hills, Cluster 2 of the Dinaric plateaus, Cluster 3 of the Dinaric plateaus, Dinaric lowlands, and Mediterranean plateaus, Cluster 4 of the Mediterranean low hills, Cluster 7 of the Pannonian low hills and Pannonian plains, Cluster 8 of the Alpine plains and Pannonian plains, and Cluster 9 of the Alpine hills and Pannonian low hills, whereas Clusters 5 and 6 are not a good approximation of even a single landscape type. Cluster 5 has the highest density (17) in the Alpine hills and Cluster 6 in the Pannonian low hills (20). Thus, Cluster 1 has a density over 22 in one landscape type of the original typology, Cluster 2 the same, Cluster 3 in four types, and Clusters 7, 8 and 9 in two types. All landscape types are represented: six in one cluster and three in two clusters. In the KMEANS classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation of the Alpine hills and Pannonian low hills, Cluster 3 of the Alpine plains and Dinaric lowlands, Cluster 4 of the Alpine mountains, Cluster 6 of the Alpine hills, Cluster 7 of the Mediterranean low hills, Cluster 8 of the Pannonian low hills and Pannonian plains, and Cluster 9 of the Dinaric plateaus, Dinaric lowlands, and Mediterranean plateaus, 15 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... LANDSCAPE TYPE GROUPS I I Alpine landscapes I I Pannonian landscapes Dinaric landscapes Mediterranean landscapes Content by: Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, Drago Perko Map by: Mauro Hrvatin © 2018, ZRC SAZU Anton Melik Geographical Institute LANDSCAPE TYPES Alpine mountains Alpine hills Alpine plains Pannonian low hills Pannonian plains Dinaric plateaus Dinaric lowlands Mediterranean low hills Mediterranean plateaus Figure 2: Nine-cluster typologies modeled using the unsupervised classification methods (in the key the clusters are ordered based on the percentage of cells in an individual cluster: the one with the highest percentage is at the top and the one with the lowest percentage is at the bottom). 16 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 whereas Clusters 2 and 5 are not a good approximation of even a single landscape type. Cluster 2 displays the highest density (21) in the Alpine mountains and Cluster 5 in the Alpine hills (18). Thus, Cluster 1 has a density above 22 in two landscape types of the original typology, as does Cluster 3, Clusters 4, 6, and 7 in one type, Cluster 8 in two types, and Cluster 9 in three types. All landscape types are represented: six in one cluster and three in two clusters. In the ISODATA classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation of the Alpine hills and Pannonian low hills, Cluster 2 of the Pannonian low hills and Pannonian plains, Cluster 3 of the Alpine hills, Cluster 4 of the Dinaric plateaus and Mediterranean plateaus, Cluster 5 of the Mediterranean low hills, Cluster 7 of the Alpine plains and Dinaric lowlands, and Cluster 9 of the Alpine mountains, whereas Clusters 6 and 8 are not a good approximation of even a single landscape type. Cluster 6 has the highest density (20) in the Alpine mountains and Cluster 8 in the Alpine hills (18). Thus, Cluster 1 has a density of over 22 in two landscape types, Cluster 2 the same, Cluster 3 in one type, Cluster 4 in two types, Cluster 5 in one type, Cluster 7 in two types, and Cluster 9 in one. All landscape types are represented: seven types in one cluster and two in two clusters. The indicator ratio between the actual and theoretical cluster frequency in the modeled typologies by landscape type of the original typology (Table 3) shows which clusters are good representatives of a specific landscape type. Good representatives are the clusters whose actual frequency is at least twice their theoretical frequency. In the CLUSTER classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation ofthe Alpine hills (a ratio of2.37), Cluster 2 of the Alpine plains (3.93) and Dinaric lowlands (2.45), Cluster 3 of the Alpine mountains (3.08), Cluster 5 of the Pannonian plains (as much as 8.99), Cluster 6 ofthe Dinaric lowlands (3.03), Mediterranean low hills (3.66), and Mediterranean plateaus (5.83), Cluster 7 of the Alpine mountains (3.09), Cluster 8 of the Dinaric plateaus (3.02) and Dinaric lowlands (2.78), and Cluster 9 of the Mediterranean low hills (as much as 9.78) and Mediterranean plateaus (even 10.79), and Cluster 4 has a ratio below 2 with all the landscape types. Its ratio is the highest with the Alpine hills (1.44). Three landscape types with a ratio above 2 appear in one cluster, four in two clusters, the Dinaric lowlands even in three clusters, and the Pannonian low hills in none. The ratio ofthe Pannonian low hills is the highest in Cluster 5 (i.e., 1.79, which is close to the threshold value of 2). In the ISOCLUST classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation of the Alpine hills (a ratio of 3.47), Cluster 2 of the Alpine mountains (2.08) and Dinaric plateaus (2.40), Cluster 3 of the Dinaric plateaus (2.35) and Mediterranean plateaus (3.29), Cluster 4 of the Mediterranean low hills (6.01), Cluster 5 of the Alpine hills (2.11), Cluster 6 of the Pannonian low hills (4.96), Cluster 7 of the Pannonian low hills (2.65) and Pannonian plains (2.73), Cluster 8 of the Alpine plains (4.88) and Pannonian plains (6.45), and Cluster 9 of the Pannonian low hills (2.94). Four landscape types with a ratio above 2 appear in one cluster, three in two clusters, and the Pannonian hills even in three clusters. In the KMEANS classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation of the Pannonian low hills (a ratio of 2.58), Cluster 2 of the Alpine mountains (2.98), Cluster 3 of the Alpine plains (4.75) and Dinaric lowlands (3.13), Cluster 4 of the Alpine mountains (5.81), Cluster 6 of the Alpine hills (3.55), Cluster 7 of the Mediterranean low hills (2.65), Cluster 8 of the Pannonian low hills (3.12) and Pannonian plains (6.21), and Cluster 9 of the Dinaric plateaus and Mediterranean plateaus, and Cluster 5 has a ratio below 2 with all the landscape types. Its ratio is the highest with the Alpine hills (1.69). Seven landscape types with a ratio above 2 appear in one cluster and two in two clusters. In the ISODATA classification, Cluster 1 is a good approximation of the Pannonian low hills (a ratio of 2.55), Cluster 2 of the Pannonian low hills (3.17) and Pannonian plains (6.12), Cluster 3 of the Alpine hills (3.55), Cluster 4 of the Dinaric plateaus (2.45) and Mediterranean plateaus (5.73), Cluster 5 of the Mediterranean low hills (6.27), Cluster 6 of the Alpine mountains (2.69), Cluster 7 of the Alpine plains (4.73) and Dinaric lowlands (3.09), and Cluster 9 of the Alpine mountains. Cluster 8 has a ratio below 2 with all the landscape types. Its ratio is the highest with the Alpine hills (1.76). Seven landscape types with a ratio above 2 appear in one cluster and two in two clusters. Taking into account all three indicators presented, the typology modeled using the iterative self-organizing data analysis method (the ISODATA module) and the typology modeled using the k-means method (the KMEANS module) are the closest to the original typology of nine landscape types. The KMEANS typology has a slightly higher correlation coefficient than the ISODATA typology but, on the other hand, the ISODATA typology displays a density above the threshold value of 22 in two clusters simultaneously only with two landscape types compared to three in the KMEANS typology. The typology modeled using the iterative self-organizing unsupervised classifier method (the ISOCLUST module) matches the original typology the least. 17 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... Table 2: Cell density of an individual cluster in the modeled typologies by nine landscape types of the original typology (green numbers indicate a density of 22 or more). Modules Alpine mountains Alpine hills Alpine plains Pannonian low hills Pannonian plains Dinaric plateaus Dinaric lowlands Mediterranean low hills Mediterranean plateaus Total CLUSTER 1 17.79 62.21 13.76 42.76 3.86 4.16 14.76 0.03 0.00 26.27 CLUSTER 2 1.25 6.12 63.91 26.86 28.21 13.01 39.76 2.60 0.27 16.26 CLUSTER 3 47.27 3.55 0.06 0.00 0.00 34.81 1.63 8.47 7.97 15.37 CLUSTER 4 10.25 18.15 4.85 16.62 0.58 13.17 8.11 17.97 1.75 12.64 CLUSTER 5 0.47 3.87 6.07 13.44 67.34 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 7.49 CLUSTER 6 1.11 0.58 0.00 0.00 0.00 10.01 19.91 24.05 38.33 6.58 CLUSTER 7 17.77 4.68 3.22 0.32 0.01 8.50 2.27 0.16 0.00 5.76 CLUSTER 8 2.02 0.82 8.12 0.00 0.00 14.74 13.56 0.13 0.31 4.88 CLUSTER 9 2.07 0.02 0.00 0.00 0.00 1.59 0.00 46.58 51.37 4.76 ISOCLUST 1 8.25 29.96 1.43 0.81 0.03 1.42 0.39 0.04 0.11 8.63 ISOCLUST 2 19.67 5.15 0.88 0.01 0.00 22.71 6.51 0.22 11.25 9.46 ISOCLUST 3 30.42 3.31 16.48 0.14 0.09 54.97 42.06 10.07 76.94 23.40 ISOCLUST 4 20.63 11.06 2.32 0.04 0.00 8.69 6.64 71.91 5.43 11.96 ISOCLUST 5 3.70 17.18 2.65 9.28 0.64 5.23 12.08 0.00 0.00 8.14 ISOCLUST 6 1.21 1.96 0.97 20.32 1.66 0.70 0.12 0.31 4.80 4.10 ISOCLUST 7 0.16 4.19 13.36 25.94 26.69 1.52 18.32 13.40 0.79 9.79 ISOCLUST 8 13.51 5.00 50.69 1.94 66.97 1.53 0.87 4.05 0.10 10.39 ISOCLUST 9 2.45 22.18 11.23 41.53 3.91 3.23 13.00 0.00 0.58 14.15 KMEANS1 6.73 29.41 11.18 42.73 3.91 3.91 11.29 0.00 0.00 16.58 KMEANS2 21.05 6.55 0.64 0.10 0.00 11.58 0.87 1.06 0.98 7.07 KMEANS 3 3.36 3.53 67.39 3.75 17.05 20.48 44.39 9.21 0.43 14.19 KMEANS 4 35.81 0.39 0.08 0.00 0.00 3.50 0.00 0.04 0.02 6.17 KMEANS 5 7.93 18.11 2.47 13.21 0.58 11.81 11.00 0.00 0.00 10.70 KMEANS 6 7.26 23.70 0.41 0.79 0.03 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 6.68 KMEANS 7 6.99 10.95 5.06 0.00 0.00 7.20 8.59 71.25 6.52 9.88 KMEANS 8 0.35 5.50 11.94 39.43 78.43 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 12.62 KMEANS 9 10.52 1.86 0.82 0.00 0.00 41.52 23.86 18.44 92.05 16.11 ISODATA 1 6.91 29.30 11.63 42.30 3.91 3.94 11.50 0.00 0.00 16.56 ISODATA 2 0.33 5.62 11.89 40.63 78.43 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 12.82 ISODATA 3 7.53 25.32 0.70 0.79 0.03 0.08 0.19 0.00 0.00 7.14 ISODATA 4 10.93 1.20 1.09 0.00 0.00 35.29 20.52 21.34 82.47 14.38 ISODATA 5 5.90 8.72 4.34 0.00 0.00 13.61 13.86 69.75 16.26 11.12 ISODATA 6 19.51 7.72 0.56 0.01 0.00 12.07 0.77 2.50 1.09 7.26 ISODATA 7 3.11 3.84 67.54 4.48 17.15 21.12 44.02 6.35 0.16 14.27 ISODATA 8 9.23 17.89 2.18 11.78 0.48 10.34 9.14 0.00 0.00 10.17 ISODATA 9 36.55 0.39 0.07 0.00 0.00 3.55 0.00 0.06 0.02 6.29 18 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Table 3: Ratio between the actual and theoretical cluster frequency in the modeled typologies by nine landscape types of the original typology (green numbers indicate ratios of 2 or more). Modules Alpine mountains Alpine hills Alpine plains Pannonian low hills Pannonian plains Dinaric plateaus Dinaric lowlands Mediterranean low hills Mediterranean plateaus Total CLUSTER 1 0.68 2.37 0.52 1.63 0.15 0.16 0.56 0.00 0.00 1.00 CLUSTER 2 0.08 0.38 3.93 1.65 1.74 0.80 2.45 0.16 0.02 1.00 CLUSTER 3 3.08 0.23 0.00 0.00 0.00 2.27 0.11 0.55 0.52 1.00 CLUSTER 4 0.81 1.44 0.38 1.31 0.05 1.04 0.64 1.42 0.14 1.00 CLUSTER 5 0.06 0.52 0.81 1.79 8.99 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 1.00 CLUSTER 6 0.17 0.09 0.00 0.00 0.00 1.52 3.03 3.66 5.83 1.00 CLUSTER 7 3.09 0.81 0.56 0.06 0.00 1.48 0.39 0.03 0.00 1.00 CLUSTER 8 0.41 0.17 1.67 0.00 0.00 3.02 2.78 0.03 0.06 1.00 CLUSTER 9 0.44 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.33 0.00 9.78 10.79 1.00 ISOCLUST 1 0.96 3.47 0.17 0.09 0.00 0.17 0.05 0.00 0.01 1.00 ISOCLUST 2 2.08 0.55 0.09 0.00 0.00 2.40 0.69 0.02 1.19 1.00 ISOCLUST 3 1.30 0.14 0.70 0.01 0.00 2.35 1.80 0.43 3.29 1.00 ISOCLUST 4 1.73 0.92 0.19 0.00 0.00 0.73 0.56 6.01 0.45 1.00 ISOCLUST 5 0.45 2.11 0.33 1.14 0.08 0.64 1.48 0.00 0.00 1.00 ISOCLUST 6 0.30 0.48 0.24 4.96 0.41 0.17 0.03 0.07 1.17 1.00 ISOCLUST 7 0.02 0.43 1.37 2.65 2.73 0.16 1.87 1.37 0.08 1.00 ISOCLUST 8 1.30 0.48 4.88 0.19 6.45 0.15 0.08 0.39 0.01 1.00 ISOCLUST 9 0.17 1.57 0.79 2.94 0.28 0.23 0.92 0.00 0.04 1.00 KMEANS 1 0.41 1.77 0.67 2.58 0.24 0.24 0.68 0.00 0.00 1.00 KMEANS 2 2.98 0.93 0.09 0.01 0.00 1.64 0.12 0.15 0.14 1.00 KMEANS 3 0.24 0.25 4.75 0.26 1.20 1.44 3.13 0.65 0.03 1.00 KMEANS 4 5.81 0.06 0.01 0.00 0.00 0.57 0.00 0.01 0.00 1.00 KMEANS 5 0.74 1.69 0.23 1.23 0.05 1.10 1.03 0.00 0.00 1.00 KMEANS 6 1.09 3.55 0.06 0.12 0.01 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 1.00 KMEANS 7 0.71 1.11 0.51 0.00 0.00 0.73 0.87 7.21 0.66 1.00 KMEANS 8 0.03 0.44 0.95 3.12 6.21 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 1.00 KMEANS 9 0.65 0.12 0.05 0.00 0.00 2.58 1.48 1.14 5.71 1.00 ISODATA 1 0.42 1.77 0.70 2.55 0.24 0.24 0.69 0.00 0.00 1.00 ISODATA 2 0.03 0.44 0.93 3.17 6.12 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 1.00 ISODATA 3 1.05 3.55 0.10 0.11 0.00 0.01 0.03 0.00 0.00 1.00 ISODATA 4 0.76 0.08 0.08 0.00 0.00 2.45 1.43 1.48 5.73 1.00 ISODATA 5 0.53 0.78 0.39 0.00 0.00 1.22 1.25 6.27 1.46 1.00 ISODATA 6 2.69 1.06 0.08 0.00 0.00 1.66 0.11 0.34 0.15 1.00 ISODATA 7 0.22 0.27 4.73 0.31 1.20 1.48 3.09 0.44 0.01 1.00 ISODATA 8 0.91 1.76 0.21 1.16 0.05 1.02 0.90 0.00 0.00 1.00 ISODATA 9 5.82 0.06 0.01 0.00 0.00 0.56 0.00 0.01 0.00 1.00 19 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... 4.2 Modeling using four clusters A graphic presentation of cluster distribution according to the four selected unsupervised classification methods using four clusters is provided in Figure 3. The original typology with four landscape type groups and the original typology with nine landscape types are added for comparison. The four-cluster typologies modeled were also compared against the original typology. Taking into account all three indicators presented, the typology modeled using the iterative self-organizing data analysis method (the ISODATA module) is the closest to the original typology with four landscape type groups and the original typology with nine landscape types, and the typology modeled using the iterative self-organizing unsupervised classifier method (the ISOCLUST module) match the original typologies the least. It is interesting that the correlation coefficients between the modeled typologies and the original typology with nine landscape types are approximately one-third higher than with the original typology with four landscape type groups. 5 Quality of the typologies modeled A comparison between the nine-cluster typologies modeled showed that the ISODATA and KMEANS typologies are the closest to the original typology with nine landscape types and can therefore be regarded as the best approximations. This applies to the modeled typologies as a whole, but the question was whether this also applies to individual landscape types or the other two modules may prove to be more effective in assigning cells to the cluster that is the best approximation of a specific landscape type (e.g., the Alpine mountains). The Herfindahl-Hirschman Index was used to calculate the concentration of nine landscape types of the original typology by nine clusters of the modeled typologies and vice versa (Tables 4 and 5). The value of the index ranges from 0 to 1. In the case presented, it had value 1 if all the cells of a specific landscape type were in only one cluster and it had value 0 if the cells of a specific landscape type were evenly distributed across all clusters. The higher the index value, the better a cluster of a specific module is an approximation of a specific landscape type. Every landscape type has the highest concentration index with one module (marked green in Table 4) and the lowest with another (marked red in Table 4). In the CLUSTER typology, two landscape types -the Alpine mountains and the Alpine hills - are the most concentrated across clusters (i.e., they have the highest concentration index), and as many as four types are concentrated the least: the Dinaric plateaus, Dinaric lowlands, Mediterranean low hills, and Mediterranean plateaus. In the ISOCLUST typology, only the Dinaric plateaus are the most concentrated across clusters, whereas as many as five are concentrated the least: the Alpine mountains, Alpine hills, Alpine plains, Pannonian low hills, and Pannonian plains. In the KMEANS typology, the three types most concentrated across clusters are the Dinaric lowlands, Mediterranean low hills, and Mediterranean plateaus, whereas no type displayed a particularly low concentration. Similarly, in the ISODATA typology, three types were most concentrated across clusters (i.e., the Alpine plains, Pannonian low hills, and Pannonian plains), and no type displayed a particularly low concentration. The values of the concentration indexes show that the CLUSTER module is the best for defining Alpine landscape types, the KMEANS module for determining Mediterranean landscape types, and the ISODATA module for defining Pannonian landscape types (Table 4). Differences between the typologies modeled are also evident from the opposite perspective - that is, in terms of cluster concentration by landscape type (Table 5). Among the nine clusters used, the CLUSTER module proved to be the best for three clusters and the worst for three clusters, the ISOCLUST module was the best for one cluster, the KMEANS module was the best for two clusters and the worst for two clusters, and the ISODATA module was the best for three clusters and the worst for as many as four (Table 5). This means that individual landscape types can be determined more effectively by other modules than the one used for a specific modeled typology; for example, the CLUSTER module for Alpine mountains and Alpine hills. The concentration index for Alpine mountains is 41% higher with the CLUSTER module than the KMEAN module, and even 93% higher for Alpine hills. The quality of the modeled typologies is also indicated by the degree of their similarity with the original typology of 1996. According to the three indicators based on which the modeled typologies were 20 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 LANDSCAPE TYPE GROUPS ■J Alpine landscapes i i Pannonian landscapes Dinaric landscapes Mediterranean landscapes Content by: Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, Drago Perko Map by: Mauro Hrvatin © 2018, ZRC SAZU Anton Melik Geographical Institute LANDSCAPE TYPES Alpine mountains Alpine hills Alpine plains Pannonian low hills Pannonian plains Dinaric plateaus Dinaric lowlands Mediterranean low hills Mediterranean plateaus Figure 3: Four-cluster typologies modeled using the unsupervised classification method (in the key the clusters are ordered based on the percentage of cells in an individual cluster: the one with the highest percentage is at the top and the one with the lowest percentage is at the bottom). 21 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... compared against the original one, the best modeled typologies are those that have the highest correlation coefficients, very high densities by individual cells of the contingency table and at the same time very low densities by other cells of the contingency table, and very high ratios by individual cells of the contingency table and at the same time very low ratios by other cells in that table. If the double density of cells in an individual cluster of modeled typologies by nine landscape types of the original typology (Table 2) is taken into account as a criterion and the frequencies in the cells of the contingency table that meet this condition are added up (values density of 20 or more are taken into account), the ISOCLUST module has 66% of all cells »properly« classified, the corresponding share with the KMEANS and ISODATA modules is 65%, and with the CLUSTER module it is 59%. Based on the criterion of the double ratio between the actual and theoretical cluster frequency of modeled typologies by nine landscape types of the original typology (Table 3), the ISOCLUST module has 56% of cells »properly« classified, compared to 53% in the KMEANS module and 51% in the ISODATA module. The differences between the modules are very small. In terms of density, nearly two-thirds of the cells are »properly« classified, compared to only just over half in terms of the frequency ratio. The degree to which the typologies modeled using unsupervised classification methods are less correlated with the original typology of 1996 compared to the typologies modeled using supervised classification methods was assessed by comparing Cramer's V (similar to how the modeled typologies were compared against the original one). The supervised classification models were designed using four supervised classification methods: a decision tree, k-nearest neighbors, maximum likelihood, and minimum distance. With all four the same four data layers were used as with the unsupervised classifications. The models were designed using two sets of training cells. For the first set, the cells were selected randomly and for the second set expert sampling was used, which means that the most representative areas were selected based on the researcher's judgment. Thus, with all methods, random supervised classifications were distinguished from the expert ones, which yielded eight modeled typologies. Typologies using supervised classification methods were modeled in 2013 (Ciglic 2014). At first glance, it may seem unusual that the typologies modeled using a random sample generally had a higher degree of correlation with the original typology (the correlation coefficient ranging from 0.5023 Table 4: Concentration indexes of landscape types of the original typology by clusters of modeled typologies (colors indicate the modeled typology or module where an individual landscape type is concentrated the most (green) or the least (red)). Modules Alpine mountains Alpine hills Alpine plains Pannonian low hills Pannonian plains Dinaric plateaus Dinaric lowlands Mediterranean low hills Mediterranean plateaus CLUSTER 1 0.4589 0.5978 0.6092 0.4618 0.6902 0.3098 0.3885 0.4789 0.5871 ISOCLUST | 0.3179 0.2962 0.4803 0.4488 0.6795 0.5353 0.3963 0.7001 0.7491 KMEANS 0.3263 0.3098 0.6479 0.5259 0.7755 0.3947 0.4439 0.7029 0.9128 ISODATA 0.3285 0.3168 0.6497 0.5292 0.7757 0.3431 0.4317 0.6920 0.8186 Average 0.3579 0.3801 0.5968 0.4914 0.7302 0.3957 0.4151 0.6435 0.7669 Table 5: Cluster concentration indexes of modeled typologies by landscape type of the original typology (colors indicate the modeled typology or module where an individual cluster is concentrated the most (green) or the least (red)). Modules Cluster 1 Cluster 2 Cluster 3 Cluster 4 Cluster 5 Cluster 6 Cluster 7 Cluster 8 Cluster 9 CLUSTER 0.5385 0.2778 0.5715 | 0.3326 0.5847 0.3768 0.4979 0.5700 0.5689 ISOCLUST | 0.7859 0.4893 0.4308 0.3715 0.4642 0.7050 0.3698 0.4110 0.4951 KMEANS 0.4869 0.5102 0.3325 0.8686 1 0.3949 0.8086 0.3881 0.5512 0.4658 ISODATA | 0.4834 0.5526 0.8075 0.4441 10.3433 0.4885 | 0.3351 0.4032 0.8698 Average 0.5737 0.4575 0.5356 0.5042 0.4468 0.5947 0.3977 0.4838 0.5999 22 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 with the minimum distance method to 0.7261 with the k-nearest neighbors method) than the ones for which an expert sample was used (0.5153 with the minimum distance method and 0.6020 with the k-nearest neighbors method). The reason is that in expert-sample modeling some of the most typical areas of individual types (based on the researcher's subjective judgment) were selected, and therefore the modeling did not cover the entire variability of a landscape type or at least not to the same extent as the random-sample modeling, where, given the more generalized classification rules, the sample was more evenly distributed across a landscape type. Hence, with expert-sample modeling one can speak of over-fitting. This is also proven by the analysis of testing the success rate of modeling the training cells, where (precisely to the contrary) expert sampling achieved significantly higher scores than random sampling (Ciglic 2014). The correlation coefficients between the typologies modeled using unsupervised classification methods and the original typology range from 0.4159 with the ISOCLUSTER module to 0.4609 with the KMEANS module. This means they are approximately one-fifth lower than the correlation coefficients between the original typology and the typologies modeled using expert supervised classification methods, and a third lower than the correlation coefficients between the original typology and the typologies modeled using random supervised classification methods. 6 Conclusion The typologies modeled using the unsupervised classification methods presented only roughly approximate the original typology of Slovenia and to a lesser degree than the supervised classification models (Ciglic 2014). This is expected because typologies modeled using supervised classification methods are based on a referential or training classification or, in this case, the 1996 typology of Slovenia. On the other hand, the statistically significant correlation between the original typology of 1996 and the typologies modeled using unsupervised classification methods (i.e., completely independently of already identified landscape types) confirms that the original landscape typology (at least in terms of the data layers that were taken into account) is fairly appropriate. However, because unsupervised classification methods have certain advantages over supervised classification methods and because the number and diversity of data covering all of Slovenian territory is growing, it can be expected that the differences between the quality of supervised and unsupervised classifications will become smaller and that modeled typologies will better approximate the actual situation, thus effectively replacing typologies produced using traditional procedures, which are usually more time-consuming and therefore more expensive. ACKNOWLEDGEMENT: The authors acknowledge financial support from the Slovenian Research Agency (program no. P6-0101: Geography of Slovenia and project no. L1-7542: Advancement of computationally intensive methods for efficient modern general-purpose statistical analysis and inference). 7 References Abonyi, J., Feil, B. 2007: Cluster analysis for data mining and system identification. Basel, Boston, Berlin, Birkhäuser. Bailey, R. G. 1996: Ecosystem geography. New York. Bastian, O. 2000: Landscape classification in Saxony (Germany) - a tool for holistic regional planning. Landscape and urban planning 50, 1-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/S0169-2046(00)00086-4 Bernert, J. A., Eilers, J. M., Freemark, K. E., Ribic, C. 1997: A quantitative method for delineating regions: An example for the western Corn Belt Plains Ecoregion of the USA. Environmental Management 21-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s002679900038 Brabyn, L. 1998: GIS analysis of macro landform. 10th colloquium of the Spatial Information Research Centre, University of Otago. Dunedin. Brabyn, L. 2018: NZ Landscape classification version II. Internet: https://www.waikato.ac.nz/eri/about/ people/larsb/New-Zealand-Landscape-Classification-v2.1.pdf (16.12.2018). Bunce, R. G. H, Barr, C. J., Clarke, R. T., Howard, D. C., Lane, A. M. J. 1996: Land classification for strategic ecological survey. Journal of environmental management 47-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1006/jema.1996.0034 23 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... Ciglič, R. 2012: Evaluation of digital data layers for establishing natural landscape types in Slovenia. Landscapes: Perception, knowledge, awareness, and action. Proceedings of the FG-SHU International Symposium on Geography. New York. Ciglič, R. 2013: Uporaba geografskih informacijskih sistemov za določanje naravnih pokrajinskih tipov Slovenije. Ph.D. thesis, Univerza v Ljubljani, Filozofska fakulteta. Ljubljana. Ciglič, R. 2014: Analiza naravnih pokrajinskih tipov Slovenije z GIS-om. Geografija Slovenije 28. Ljubljana. Ciglič, R. 2018: Assessing the impact of input data incongruity in selected quantitative methods for modelling natural landscape typologies. Geografski vestnik 90-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/GV90107 Ciglič, R., Geršič, M., Perko, D., Zorn, M. (eds.) 2016: Digitalni podatki. GIS v Sloveniji 13. Ljubljana. Ciglič, R., Perko, D. 2012: Slovenia in geographical typifications and regionalizations of Europe. Geografski vestnik 84-1. Ciglič, R., Perko, D. 2013: Europe's landscape hotspots. Acta geographica Slovenica 53-1. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.3986/AGS53106 Ciglič, R., Perko, D. 2015: Modelling as a method for evaluating natural landscape typology: The case of Slovenia. Landscape Analysis and Planning. Cham. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-319-13527-4 Ciglič, R., Perko, D. 2017: A method for evaluating raster data layers according to landscape classification scale. Ecological Informatics 39. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ecoinf.2017.03.004 Ciglič, R., Perko, D., Hrvatin, M., Štrumbelj, E. 2017: Modeling and evaluating older landscape classifications with modern quantitative methods. From pattern and process to people and action. Ghent. Clark, A. N. 1998: The Penguin dictionary of geography. London. Demeritt, D., Wainwright, J. 2005: Models, modelling and geography. Questioning geography: fundamental Debates. Malden. Dikau, R., Brabb, E. E., Mark, R. K. 1991: Landform classification of New Mexico by computer. Menlo Park. Dodge, Y. 2008: The concise encyclopedia of statistics. New York. Eastman, J. R. 2016: TerrSet. Geospatial Monitoring and Modeling System. Manual. Worcester. Ellison, A. M. 2010: Repeatability and transparency in ecological research. Ecology 91-9. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1890/09-0032.1 Ferligoj, A. 1989: Razvrščanje v skupine. Teorija in uporaba v družboslovju. Ljubljana. Gabrovec, M., Hrvatin, M. 1998: Površje. Geografski atlas Slovenije. Ljubljana. Gallant, A. L., Douglas, D. B., Hoffer, R. M. 2005: Automated mapping of Hammond's landforms. IEEE geoscience and remote sensing letters 2-4. Piscataway. Gams, I. 1983: Geografske značilnosti Slovenije. Ljubljana. Gams, I. 1984: Metodologija geografske razčlenitve ozemlja. Geografski vestnik 56. Gams, I. 1998: Pokrajinsko ekološka sestava Slovenije. Geografija Slovenije. Ljubljana. Gams, I., Kladnik, D., Orožen Adamič, M. 1995: Naravnogeografske regije Slovenije. Krajevni leksikon Slovenije. Ljubljana. Haggett, P. 2001: Geography: a global synthesis. Harlow. Hammond, E. H. 1964: Analysis of properties in landform geography: An application to broadscale landform mapping. Annals of Association of American Geographers 54-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1111/ j.1467-8306.1964.tb00470.x Hazeu, G. W., Metzger, M. J., Mucher, C. A., Perez-Soba, M., Renetzeder, C., Andersen, E. 2011: European environmental stratifications and typologies: An overview. Agriculture, ecosystems and environment 142, 1-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016Zj.agee.2010.01.009 Hrvatin, M., Perko, D. 2012: Morphological typifications of Slovenia's surface using global classification methods. Geografski vestnik 84-1. Ilešič, S. 1956: Slovenske pokrajine. Geografski obzornik 3-2. Ilešič, S. 1958: Problemi geografske rajonizacije ob primeru Slovenije. Geografski vestnik 29-30. Iwahashi, J., Pike, R. J. 2006: Automated classifications of topography from DEMs by an unsupervised nested-means algorithm and a three-part geometric signature. Geomorphology 86, 3-4. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/j.geomorph.2006.09.012 Jiang, B., Ding, X., Ma, L., He, Y., Wang, T., Xie, W. 2008: A hybrid feature selection algorithm: combination of symmetrical uncertainty and genetic algorithms. Optimization and systems biology. Lijiang. 24 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Jongman, R. H. G., Bunce, R. G. H., Metzger, M. J., Mücher, C. A., Howard, D. C., Mateus, V. L. 2006: Objectives and applications of a statistical environmental stratification of Europe. Landscape Ecology 21-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s10980-005-6428-0 Kladnik, D. 1996: Naravnogeografske členitve Slovenije. Geografski vestnik 68. Kladnik, D., Perko, D., Urbanc, M. 2009: Cultural landscapes in Slovenia from geographical perspective. Cultural landscape - Across disciplines. Kraków. Loveland, T. R., Merchant, J. M. 2004: Ecoregions and ecoregionalization: geographical and ecological perspectives. Environmental Management 34-S1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s00267-003-5181-x McGarigal, K., Cushman, S., Stafford, S. 2000: Multivariate statistics for wildlife and ecology research. New York. McMahon, G., Wiken, E. B., Gauthier, D. A. 2004: Toward a scientifically rigorous basis for developing mapped ecological regions. Environmental Management 34-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s00267-004-0170-2 Melik, A. 1935: Slovenija - geografski opis. Ljubljana. Melik, A. 1946: Prirodnogospodarska sestava Slovenije. Geografski vestnik 18. Mücher, C. A., Bunce, R. G. H., Jongman, R. H. G., Klijn, J. A., Koomen, A. J. M., Metzger, M. J., Wascher, D. M. 2003: Identification and characterisation of environments and landscapes in Europe. Alterra rapport 832. Wageningen. Natek, K. 1993: Tipi površja v Sloveniji. Geografski obzornik 40-4. Natek, K., Žiberna, I. 2004: Naravnogeografske regionalizacije Slovenije. Teorija in praksa regionalizacije Slovenije. Maribor. Olson, D. M., Dinerstein, E., Wikramanayake, E. D., Burgess, N. D., Powell, G. V. N., Underwood, E. C., D'Amico, J. A., Itoua, I., Strand, H. E., Morrison, J. C., Loucks, C. J., Allnut, T. F., Ricketts, T. H., Kura, Y., Lamoreux, J. F., Wettengel, W W, Hedao, P., Kassem, K. R. 2001: Terrestrial ecoregions of the World: a new map of life on earth: A new global map of terrestrial ecoregions provides an innovative tool for conserving biodiversity. BioScience 51-11. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1641/0006-3568(2001)051 [0933:TEOTWA]2.0.CO;2 Oštir, K. 2006: Daljinsko zaznavanje. Ljubljana. Pan-European Biological and Landscape diversity strategy, 1996. Internet: https://www.unibuc.ro/prof/ patru-stupariu_i_g/docs/2014/noi/03_11_52_38paneurop_strategie.pdf (12.12.2018). Perko, D. 1998: Regionalizacija Slovenije. Geografski zbornik 38. Perko, D. 2001: Analiza površja Slovenije s stometrskim digitalnim modelom reliefa. Geografija Slovenije 3. Ljubljana. Perko, D. 2007: Landscapes. Slovenia in focus. Ljubljana. Perko, D., Hrvatin, M. 2009: Določanje morfoloških enot površja v Sloveniji s prirejeno Hammondovo metodo. Geografski vestnik 81-2. Perko, D., Hrvatin M., Ciglič, R. 2015: A methodology for natural landscape typification of Slovenia. Acta geographica Slovenica 55-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.1938 Plut, D. 1999: Regionalizacija Slovenije po sonaravnih kriterijih. Geografski vestnik 71. Plut, D. 2005: Teoretična in vsebinska zasnova trajnostno sonaravnega napredka. Dela 23. DOI: https://doi.org/10.4312/dela.23.59-113 Pravilnik o določanju in vodenju bonitete zemljišč. Uradni list Republike Slovenije 47/2008. Ljubljana. Richards, J., Jia, X. 2006: Remote sensing digital image analysis: an introduction. Berlin, Heidelberg. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-642-30062-2 Rogerson, P. A. 2006: Statistical methods for geography: a student guide. London, Thousand Oaks, New Delhi. Romportl, D., Chuman, T. 2012: Proposal method of landscape typology in the Czech Republic. Journal of landscape ecology 5-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.2478/v10285-012-0057-5 Runhaar, H. J., Udo de Haes, H. A. 1994: The use of site factors as classification characteristiccs for ecotopes. Ecosystem classification for environmental management. Dordrecht. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/ 978-94-017-1384-9_7 Špes, M., Cigale, D., Lampič, B., Natek, K., Plut, D., Smrekar, A. 2002: Študija ranljivosti okolja. Geographica Slovenica 35, 1-2. Ljubljana. 25 Drago Perko, Rok Ciglic, Mauro Hrvatin, The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification ... TerrSet Help System. Clark Labs. Worcester, 2015. Internet: https://clarklabssf.wpengine.com/wp-content/ uploads/2015/07/TerrSet-Help-System.zip (12.12.2018). Tirelli, T., Pessani, D. 2011: Importance of feature selection in decision-tree and artificial-neural-network ecological applications. Alburnus alburnus alborella: A practical example. Ecological Informatics 6-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ecoinf.2010.11.001 The European Landscape Convention. Internet: https://www.coe.int/en/web/landscape/home (10.9.2018). Theodoridis, S., Koutroumbas, K. 2006: Pattern recognition. San Diego. Udo de Haes, H. A., Klijn, F. 1994: Environmental policy and ecosystem classification. Ecosystem classification for environmental management. Dordrecht. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/978-94-017-1384-9_1 Verbič, T. 1998: Kamnine. Geografski atlas Slovenije. Ljubljana. Warner, T. A., Campagna, D. J. 2009: Remote sensing with Idrisi® Taiga. A beginner's guide. Hong Kong. Whittow, J. B. 2000: Dictionary of physical geography. London. Zupančič, M., Marinček, L., Puncer, I., Seliškar, A. 1998: Potencialno naravna vegetacija. Geografski atlas Slovenije. Ljubljana. 26 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 27-42 HOUSEHOLD EARTHQUAKE PREPAREDNESS IN SERBIA: A STUDY OF SELECTED MUNICIPALITIES Vladimir M. Cvetkovic, Kevin Ronan, Rajib Shaw, Marina Filipovic, Rita Mano, Jasmina Gacic, Vladimir Jakovljevic Aftermath of the Kraljevo earthquake. Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.5445 UDC: 614.8:550.34(497.11) COBISS: 1.01 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities ABSTRACT: This article presents the results of a qualitative study of household earthquake and communitylevel preparedness in Serbia and its relationship to various demographic factors. A series of 1,018 face-to-face interviews were conducted at the beginning of 2017 in eight Serbian municipalities. The results show that the population is generally unprepared, with low percentages of reported enhanced preparedness levels. In addition to presenting its findings, the study also considers future research directions, including using this study as a basis for more detailed research and to assist in facilitating community-led programs and strategies to increase earthquake safety. KEY WORDS: geography, natural hazards, earthquake, preparedness, household, survey, Serbia Pripravljenost gospodinjstev na potrese v Srbiji: Študija izbranih občin IZVLEČEK: V članku so predstavljeni rezultati kvalitativne študije pripravljenosti na potres v gospodinjstvih in na občinski ravni v Srbiji in njeni povezanosti različnimi demografskimi dejavniki. Članek temelji na 1018 intervjujih, ki so bili izvedeni na začetku leta 2017 v osmih srbskih občinah. Rezultati kažejo, da je prebivalstvo na splošno nepripravljeno, z nizkim deležem izboljšane ravni pripravljenosti. Poleg lastnih ugotovitev študija obravnava tudi prihodnje smeri raziskovanja, vključno z uporabo te študije kot temelja za podrobnejše raziskave in za pomoč pri programih, ki jih vodijo skupnosti, ter strategij za povečanje potresne varnosti. KLJUČNE BESEDE: geografija, naravne nesreče, potres, pripravljenost, gospodinjstvo, raziskovanje, Srbija Vladimir M. Cvetkovic, Marina Filipovic, Jasmina Gačic, Vladimir Jakovljevic University of Belgrade, Faculty of Security Studies vmc@fb.bg.ac.rs, fmarina@fb.bg.ac.rs, jgacic@sezampro.rs, vjakov@fb.bg.ac.rs Kevin Ronan Central Queensland University, Clinical Psychology School of Human, Health and Social Sciences k.ronan@cqu.edu.au Rajib Shaw Keio University, Graduate School of Media and Governance shaw@sfc.keio.ac.jp Rita Mano University of Haifa, Department of Human Services ritamano@research.haifa.ac.il The article was submitted for publication on October 10th, 2017. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 10. oktobra 2017. 28 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction Disasters caused by earthquakes present various threats to human society and are generally seen as processes resulting from the interaction between natural and anthropogenic systems (Lukic et al. 2013). The preparedness of individuals, households, and communities is very important for improving community resilience in the face of any natural hazards, especially with regard to modern society's great vulnerability to earthquakes (Komac et al. 2013). Disaster preparedness is defined as self-protective or precautionary behavior (Mishra and Suar 2012), but preparedness activities are usually not engaged in at the household level (e.g., Eisenman et al. 2006; Kapucu 2008; Bethel, Foreman, and Burke 2011; Marti et al. 2018). More recent studies have highlighted the factors associated with earthquake preparedness at the household and community levels (Murphy et al. 2009; FEMA 2009; Johnston, Becker and Paton 2012; Muttarak and Pothisiri 2013; Paton et al. 2015; Cvetkovic et al. 2015; Deyoung and Peters 2016; Johnson and Nakayachi 2017; Fox et al. 2017). First, demographic and socioeconomic variables are a central set of characteristics linked to preparedness. Older, female, and better-educated heads of households, as well as residence duration, tend to be associated with better household preparedness (Duval and Mulilis 1999; Shaw et al. 2004). On the other hand, better community preparedness has been associated with non-single status and farming occupations (Tomio et al. 2014; Ashida et al. 2017). Second, recent studies (Kirschenbaum 2006; Tomio et al. 2014) have found that the relationship between household and community preparedness is not complementary, and, as a result, a large proportion of households are unprepared at both the community and household levels (Kirschenbaum, Rapaport and Canetti 2017). In practice, disaster management authorities often do not implement any activities related to earthquake preparedness at local levels, and they focus more on reactive and top-down approaches (Ainuddin and Routray 2012). This study gathered basic data necessary for understanding preparedness and for use in preparedness planning and programs. Proceeding from this basis, it examined preparedness perceptions, knowledge, and behaviors, including investigation of the role of demographic factors (sex, age, education level, marital status, and household income) influencing household earthquake preparedness in Serbia. Such variations reflect the extent to which factors can shape community-driven efforts and education, supporting efforts to prepare for and cope with an earthquake. Based on the findings, the article suggests some specific initiatives that can be taken to improve preparedness in Serbia. 2 Study area Serbia belongs to a region with moderate seismic activity in terms of the number and frequency of earthquakes as well as their magnitude, and it is characterized by an irregular distribution of epicenters, which makes it difficult to distinguish seismically active faults (Marovic et al. 2002; Abolmasov et al. 2011; Dragicevic et al. 2011). Marovic et al. (2002) found that, from 1900 to 1970, stronger-intensity earthquakes (determined as I = VIII-IX) were registered at the following locations: Rudnik (a mountain), Lazarevac (a municipality of the city of Belgrade), Juhor (a mountain), Krupanj (a town and municipality in the Macva district of western Serbia), Jagodina (a city and the administrative center of the Pomoravlje district in central Serbia), Vranje (a city and the administrative center of the Pcinja district in southern Serbia), and Vitina (a town and municipality in eastern Kosovo), and, from 1970 onwards, only three moderate-intensity earthquakes have occurred: at Kopaonik (a mountain), Mionica (a town and municipality in the Kolubara district of western Serbia), and Trstenik (a town and municipality in the Rasina district of central Serbia). The most seismically threatened is Lazarevac, where an extreme earthquake (M = 6.1) was recorded in 1922. Near the city of Kraljevo, Serbia, with a population of more than 100,000, an M = 5.4 earthquake occurred on November 3rd, 2010. Over the next six days, 258 earthquakes were registered, with magnitudes ranging from 1.0 to 4.4. Despite the moderate magnitude of the incident, two people were killed, many others were injured, and the total damage to the city was assessed at more than €100 million (Panic et al. 2013). By the end of March 2011, the earthquake had been followed by a sequence of more than 650 aftershocks of a magnitude greater than 1.0 (Antonijevic, Arroucanu and Vlahovic 2013). 29 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities Figure 1: Earthquake intensity zones (hundred-year return period) in Serbia and the number of respondents in the municipalities studied. 30 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 3 Methods Preparedness research investigates individuals' perceived readiness before a disaster event and takes into account all mitigation actions and response behaviors in the aftermath of the emergency (Mulilis and Lippa 1990; Paton 2003). With regard to preparedness, the following dimensions were examined: perceived preparedness and household safety (Dooley et al. 1992; Levac, Toal-Sullivan and O'Sullivan 2012), storage of emergency food and supplies (Baker 2011), knowledge and availability of shelter (Kohn et al. 2012), and special support and assistance (Flynn et al. 1999). A series of 1,018 face-to-face interviews were conducted at the beginning of 2017 in eight of Serbia's 150 municipalities. These communities were chosen with reference to the national map of seismic regionalization of Serbia with a return period of one hundred years (Vukasinovic 1987) and their various demographic and social characteristics. The participants in these municipalities were selected randomly, with the number of respondents proportional to their size (0.2-0.9%), thus providing a random selection and a representative sampling approach (Paul and Bhuiyan 2010). The communities where the interviews took place were Kraljevo (330), Lazarevac (190), Jagodina (150), Mionica (fifty), Vranje (eighty), Prijepolje (one hundred), Lapovo (sixty and Kopaonik (fifty-eight; Figure 1). Using a multistage random sample, in the first stage we singled out these communities, and then in the second stage we selected particular streets and parts of the streets. Finally, we selected various households, where the survey was conducted. The respondents were determined based on a random selection procedure of adult household members, where an individual over eighteen was interviewed and presented with a structured questionnaire. 3.1 Survey instruments A structured questionnaire was set up using a combination of qualitative (close-ended) multiple-choice questions and five-point Likert scales (Joshi et al. 2015). The first part of the questionnaire is related to the demographic and socioeconomic characteristics of the interviewees (e.g., sex, age, and level of education). Subsequent sections included questions relating to perceived preparedness and household safety (variables about household preparedness, community preparedness, geological layers under the house, earthquake-proof houses, reinforced houses, furniture secured to walls, and well-reinforced houses), essential supplies (variables about a prepared emergency kit, examination of the contents of the emergency kit, easy access to the emergency kit, possession of a sufficient emergency stock, and community-stored emergency supplies), shelter (variables about designated shelter nearby, familiarization with the route to the shelter, obstacles on the route to the shelter, alerting neighbors before evacuation, the state of the shelter, and familiarization with the management of shelters), and special support and assistance (variables about special care in cases of disaster, knowledge about situations when the dead and injured are elderly, difficulties in evacuating family members, dealing with the elderly, handicapped, and infants, knowledge about guiding the hearing or visually impaired, and familiarization with kinds of support for the elderly). Each item was rated on a five-point Likert scale (1 = strongly disagree, 5 = strongly agree). The items here were developed after consulting several published survey approaches (Mulilis, Duval and Lippa 1990; Matsuda and Okada 2006; Spittal et al. 2006; Ardalan and Sohrabizadeh 2016). A pilot pre-test of the questionnaire was also conducted in Belgrade to check the comprehension and performance of the questionnaire. 3.2 Sample The interviewees, 46.9% women and 50.1% men (97% fully completed the questionnaire), were representative ofthe sex stratification of Serbian population, with 51.3% women and 48.7% men. The average age of respondents was 36 (population average: 42.6), and the largest category was those under 36. The sample implies that the majority of respondents had a secondary education (population average: primary 20.76%, secondary 48.93%, and associate's degree 15.1%, according to Statistical Office of the Republic of Serbia). In the household sample, married people accounted for 45% of the sample (population average: single 27.91%, married 55.12%, widowed 11.64%, and divorced 4.93%). The majority of respondents were unemployed (population average: employed 29.3%), and the monthly income at the family level was reported to be up 31 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities to €750 (population average: €480). The interviewees also had different homeownership statuses: family member (61.1%), owners (29.7%), and rented (8.8%; Table 1). Table 1: Socioeconomic and demographic information of respondents (number of responders). Variable and number of respondents Category n % Sex (1,016) Male 476 46.9 Female 540 50.1 Age (1,018) Young (18-38) 564 46.6 Middle-aged (39-60) 354 34.7 Elderly (over 60) 100 9.8 Education level (644) Primary 12 1.2 Secondary 294 28.9 Associate's degree 102 10.0 Bachelor's degree 194 19.1 Graduate degree 42 4.1 Marital status (786) Single 294 28.9 Married 458 45.0 Divorced 30 2.9 Widowed 4 0.4 Homeownership (1,014) Personal 302 29.7 Family member 622 61.1 Rented 90 8.8 Employment status (1,014) Employed 442 43.4 Unemployed 572 56.2 Monthly family income (€, 1018) Up to 210 152 14.9 Up to 420 304 29.9 Up to 630 382 37.5 Up to 750 130 12.8 Over 751 50 4.9 4 Results 4.1 Perceived preparedness and household safety In terms of preparedness levels, the mean estimate of households' preparedness was 3.02 out of 5, and for the local community 2.76 out of 5. In categorical terms, these mean scores reflect approximately the midpoint on a five-point Likert scale, and in this case endorsement centered around 3, »neither prepared nor unprepared.« Thus, in terms of categorical placement, the highest percentage of respondents said that their household is neither prepared nor unprepared to respond (39.5%), 31.5% stated prepared, and 29.0% said they were unprepared to respond. Focusing on the perceptions of community preparedness and translating the mean score of 3.02 in categorical terms, the largest percentage of respondents (44.0%) reported that the local community is unprepared for reaction, 33.2% stated neither prepared nor unprepared, and 22.8% said they were prepared to respond. The largest percentage of respondents (54.9%) reported having no knowledge of the geology under the house. In terms of buildings being reinforced, 40.0% reported that they do not know whether the buildings are reinforced against an earthquake (Figure 2). Considering differences in gender roles and responsibilities, males were found to have higher percentages in the following categories: perception that their households were prepared, that the local community was 32 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 prepared, that they knew what kind of geological layers existed under the house, and that they were more likely to reinforce buildings. In contrast, women were found to have higher percentages in the following areas: they checked their houses for earthquake resilience, reinforced the house, and secured furniture (Table 2). In terms of age, the results show that, compared to the middle-aged and elderly, young people had higher percentages in the following categories: that the household and local community was prepared, that the house was checked for earthquake resilience, that they secured furniture, and that they reinforced buildings. Compared to middle-aged and young people, elderly people reported higher percentages of awareness about what kind of geological layers were under the house (Table 2). 1 2 3 4 5 Likert scale ■ Household preparedness ■ Community preparedness Geological layers under the house ■ Buildings reinforced well Figure 2: Percentage of respondents and related Likert scale value for perceived preparedness and household safety. Table 2: Cross-tabulation between sex, age, and perceived preparedness and household safety variables Variables Descriptive Sex Age M SD M % F % x2 P x2 Y MA E P Household preparedness 3.02 1.16 32.8 30.0 10.1 .038* 164.4 45.1 19.0 16.0 .000** Community preparedness 2.76 1.13 23.5 21.8 28.6 .000** 184.5 30.4 14.1 10.0 .000** Geological layers under house 2.14 1.30 18.0 14.0 16.0 .003* 136.1 15.2 26.4 28.0 .000** Earthquake-proof house 1.91 0.29 12.6 5.5 15.3 .000** 39.8 14.8 8.5 2.0 .000** Reinforced house 1.29 0.45 64.1 76.7 20.4 .000** 56.5 75.4 64.2 44.0 .000** Secured furniture to wall 1.94 0.36 22.3 8.0 41.7 .000** 16.5 18.1 17.0 2.0 .002* Buildings reinforced well 3.17 1.16 36.7 24.6 15.9 .003* 159.5 32.3 45.0 30.0 .000** Note: M = male, F = female, Y = young, MA = middle-aged, E = elderly. **Correlation is significant at the 0.01 level (two-tailed). *Correlation is significant at the 0.05 level (two-tailed). 33 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities 4.2 Essential supplies The results of the descriptive statistical analysis in this participant sample indicated that 67% of participants reported preparing an emergency kit, 49% examining the contents of the emergency kit regularly, 62% having easy access to an emergency kit, 37% having emergency stocks, 34% having sufficient stocks, and 40% that their community stored emergency supplies (Figure 3). Chi-square analyses indicated that higher percentages of men than women reported the following: having easier access to an emergency kit, having emergency stock, and that the community stored emergency supplies. In contrast, a higher percentage of women than men reported the following: preparing an emergency kit, examining the contents of emergency kits, and ensuring stock sufficiency (Table 3). Women were again more active in carrying out preparedness, whereas men were more likely to have favorable perceptions of preparedness. 100 95 90 85 80 75 70 65 60 55 50 45 40 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 Examine the Easily access Have emergency contens of of emergency kit stock emergency kit Storage ■ Yes ■ No Community store emergency supplies Figure 3: Descriptive statistical analysis regarding essential supplies. Table 3: Cross-tabulation between sex, age, and essential supply variables Variables Descriptive Sex Age M SD M % F % x2 P x2 Y MA E p Prepared an emergency kit 1.33 0.47 61.8 70.7 24.2 .000** 45.1 39.0 36.0 90.5 .000** Contents of emergency kit 1.55 0.50 47.1 52.2 4.6 .096 57.0 54.0 36.0 27.9 .000** Easily access of emergency kit 1.37 0.48 66.1 59.9 4.0 .050* 68.9 64.0 55.1 26.0 .000** Have emergency stock 1.62 0.48 41.6 35.1 4.5 .033* 44.7 28.0 25.0 45.2 .000** Sufficient stock 2.11 1.17 7.0 12.6 23.9 .000** 28.3 44.3 36.7 292.2 .000** Communal emergency supplies 1.59 0.49 34.0 46.7 11.7 .001** 57.8 20.6 17.0 119.6 .000** Note: M = male, F = female, Y = young, MA = middle-aged, E = elderly. **Correlation is significant at the 0.01 level (two-tailed). *Correlation is significant at the 0.05 level (two-tailed). 34 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 This study found that higher percentages of young people reported the following: preparing an emergency kit, having easy access to an emergency kit, having an emergency stock, and that their community stored emergency supplies. In contrast, a higher percentage of middle-aged people reported the following: examining the contents of emergency kits and ensuring stock sufficiency (Table 3). 4.3 Shelter following an earthquake In terms of sex differences, a higher percentage of males than females reported the following: knowing the route to the shelter, being familiar with the obstacles on the route to the shelter, awareness of the conditions of a provided anticipated shelter, and being familiar with the shelter management. In contrast, and consistent with the pattern of findings thus far on behavior-related sex differences, a higher percentage 100 95 90 85 80 75 70 65 60 55 50 45 40 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 Designated shelter nearby Knowing management of shelters Shelter Yes ■ No Figure 4: Descriptive statistical analysis regarding shelters. Table 4: Cross-tabulation between sex, age, and shelter variables Variables Descriptive Sex Age M SD M % F % x2 P x2 Y MA E p Designated shelter nearby 1.77 0.41 24.0 21.0 1.91 .166 34.6 31.0 16.9 104.4 .000** Route to shelter 1.76 0.42 24.8 21.2 13.5 .001** 35.9 30.0 14.0 126.3 .000** Obstacles on route to shelter 2.61 0.59 6.4 5.2 48.6 .000** 8.4 1.0 4.1 135.2 .000** Calling neighbors 1.29 1.45 88.0 94.0 31.5 .000** 86.9 97.0 100.0 101.5 .000** Condition of shelter 1.85 0.98 19.3 18.1 16.6 .002* 28.3 22.2 12.7 0.3 .124 Management of shelters 2.34 2.94 13.0 7.8 51.3 .000** 19.4 1.0 2.5 84.9 .000** Note: M = male, F = female, Y = young, MA = middle-aged, E = elderly. **Correlation is significant at the 0.01 level (two-tailed). *Correlation is significant at the 0.05 level (two-tailed). 35 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities of women than men reported that they would call their neighbors before evacuating. Regarding age effects, a higher percentage of young people reported knowing the route to the shelter, having a designated shelter nearby, being aware of obstacles on the route to an anticipated shelter, being aware of the conditions of an anticipated shelter, and being familiar with the shelter management. In contrast, a higher percentage of older adults reported that they would call their neighbors before evacuating (Table 4; Figure 4). 4.4 Support and assistance Research has found that just under half (44%) could name an individual that would require special care in the event of a disaster. This included 31% of the total sample that reported having knowledge of older adults, the disabled, or infants that might require support and assistance; 26% reported having knowledge 100 95 90 85 80 75 -70 -65 60 -55 -50 -45 -40 35 30 -25 -20 -15 10 5 0 Difficulty in evacuation in family Special support and assistance Knowing guide Knowing of hearin or kind support sight impaired the elderly Yes No Figure 5: Descriptive statistical analysis regarding special support and assistance. Table 5: Cross-tabulation between sex, age, and special support and assistance variables Variables Descriptive Sex M SD M % F % x2 P x2 Y MA E p Special care in a disaster 1.90 0.88 36.0 51.1 57.5 .000** 51.5 36.8 32.0 54.1 .000** Dead and injured elderly 3.39 1.45 38.1 46.0 32.2 .000** 44.0 41.0 20.0 152.6 .000** Difficulty in family evacuation 1.76 0.42 21.3 24.9 8.9 .030* 21.1 34.0 6.0 61.1 .000** Elderly, handicapped, infants 2.75 1.50 34.0 32.0 6.6 .156 26.3 36.8 62.0 0.30 .152 Hearing or visually impaired 2.63 1.50 22.1 29.2 13.3 .010* 27.0 28.3 46.0 191.2 .000** How to support the elderly 3.22 1.41 24.9 47.7 45.9 .000** 50.1 58.5 32.0 115.6 .000** Note: M = male, F = female, Y = young, M M = middle -aged, E = elderly. *Correlation is significant at the 0.01 level (two-tailed). *Correlation is significant at the 0.05 level (two-tailed). 36 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 of individuals with hearing or visual impairments; and 23% were aware of difficulties related to family evacuation. In terms of other findings here, 42% reported knowing what kind of support is needed by the elderly and 44% knowing that the elderly are more vulnerable to life-threatening injuries (Figure 5). In terms of sex differences in relation to assistance and support factors, a higher percentage of women than men reported the following: knowing somebody that would need special care in the event of a disaster, anticipating difficulties in family evacuation, and knowing people with hearing or visual impairments that might require assistance. They also reported better knowledge of the kind of support required by the elderly, who are also more vulnerable (Table 5). A higher percentage of young people reported knowing somebody that would need special care in the event of a disaster and knowing that older adults are more vulnerable. A higher percentage of middle-aged people reported anticipating difficulties in family evacuation and being aware of the kind of support older adults might require. Finally, a higher percentage of older adults reported knowing people with hearing or visual impairments that might require assistance (Table 5). 5 Discussion Many countries have promoted the idea that households should prepare essential survival items, make a plan, improve survival skills, and facilitate people's ability to cope with the consequences of an earthquake (Russell, Goltz and Bourque 1995; Spittal et al. 2008; Becker et al. 2012; Jamshidi et al. 2016). However, a number of national and international studies have shown that levels of earthquake preparedness are generally low (Russell, Goltz and Bourque 1995; Mileti and Darlington 1997; Ronan and Johnston 2005; Azim and Islam 2016). Motivating people to prepare can be a difficult task, and much research has identified specific demographic, socioeconomic, and psychological factors that predict preparedness behaviors (Russell, Goltz and Bourque 1995; Rossi 1990; Paton et al. 2010; Solberg, Rossetto and Joffe 2010; Johnson and Nakayachi 2017; Cvetkovic, Gacic and Ristanovic 2018). Lack of social responsibility (e.g., insufficient insurance policies) can also be a very important factor in the preparedness process (Zorn and Komac 2015). The findings on the mean estimates of households' preparedness (a somewhat low level) are consistent with some other studies (Russell, Goltz and Bourque 1995; Mileti and Darlington 1997; Spittal et al. 2008; Johnson and Nakayachi 2017). For example, a study about perceptions of earthquake preparedness of households in Saudi Arabia found that residents of Jeddah were mostly not prepared (Azim and Islam 2016). Similarly, this study showed that the highest percentage of respondents said their household is neither prepared nor unprepared to respond. This could be linked to the fact that Serbia does not have education strategies, an awareness program, drills, or a campaign for earthquakes. Devi and Sharma (2015) found that less than half of adults had adequate practice in earthquake preparedness in Nepal. Becker et al. (2012) found that household earthquake preparedness still remains at modest levels despite the importance of preparing (e.g., Napier, Wanganui, & Timaru in New Zealand). Ronan and Johnston (2005) also found that overall levels of earthquake preparation are universally low, including in risk-prone areas (e.g., California, Turkey, and Japan). Taken together, the results of descriptive analyses showed that the largest percentage of respondents reported that the local community is unprepared for reaction, lacking knowledge about the geological layers under houses and not knowing whether the buildings are reinforced or whether they are earthquake-resistant. Given the overall low levels of preparedness, including relevant knowledge, this points to identification of the factors that can assist emergency management agencies and other disaster risk reduction and safety organizations to tailor communication to enhance knowledge, motivation, and specific preparedness activities. In contrast, in lower seismicity contexts, perceptions are typically lower. Regarding the effects of sex, the findings in our study are mixed, which is consistent with some previous studies (e.g., Able and Nelson 1990). For example, a higher percentage of men felt that their households were prepared and, in contrast, a higher percentage of women checked their houses for earthquake resistance. The results can be related to certain studies that found that women are less likely to be prepared (Hackl, Halla and Pruckner 2007). Other research and reviews have supported the notion that in many households women often take more responsibility for household matters, including disaster preparedness (Ersing et al. 2015). In Serbia, men traditionally perform more physical labor, which may then have implications for household and community preparedness (Pesic 2006). On the other hand, women are traditionally 37 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities seen as housekeepers and childminders. Such findings, of course, have implications for preparedness communication, including specific guidance coupled with the notion of both women and men working together in household and community terms and possible enhanced effects of balancing levels of preparedness with reality. In addition, this combination of findings has implications for both planning shelters and preparedness communication within the community (Woersching and Snyder 2003; Liu, Ruan and Shi 2011). Compared to middle-aged and elderly people, young people perceived the preparedness and household safety in a different way. These results are consistent with a previous study by Sattler, Kaiser, and Hittner (2000), which found a positive relationship between older age and personal disaster preparedness. Research has also found that older adults are typically more emotionally resilient to the effects of natural disasters, compared to younger people (Heller et al. 2005). Compared to middle-aged and young people, a higher percentage of elderly people also reported awareness of what kind of geological layers lie under the house. Based on this, it can be assumed that older people mostly built their own houses and as a result are more familiar with the characteristics of the area or have a fear of earthquakes. Reasons for this may be previous experience, both general life experience as well as having experienced and coped with previous hazard events (Norris et al. 2002). Given this range of findings, emergency communication and education that features a cooperative, participatory approach may then benefit from the relative strengths and tendencies seen within different age cohorts. Generally, the reasons for engaging in initial and sustained preparedness include people reporting a desire to be prepared and, over time, to keep their supplies fresh and/or in working order in case they have to use them. Protection motivation theory (Maddux and Rogers 1983) and theory of planned behavior (Ajzen 1991, 2011) may be used as a framework for understanding various preparedness behaviors. People that do replenish their emergency supplies report wanting to ensure they have safe drinking water and food (Page et al. 2008; Kapucu 2008; Becker et al. 2012). There are groups within any community that may require additional support and assistance following an earthquake (Tanida 1996; Matsuda and Okada 2006; WHO 2008; Cvetkovic, Milasinovic and Lazic 2018). Often, however, marginal groups are not considered in disaster planning (Heller et al. 2005; Zorn 2018). In an urban area, earthquakes have been found to cause especially heavy damage to the inner-city housing of low-income people and the elderly (Hirayama 2000). This idea is buttressed by our findings that just under half could name an individual that would require special care during a disaster. 6 Conclusion Taken together, this study contributes new information that can be used to assist in local and national emergency management communication to improve household earthquake preparedness. The fact that a relatively low number of participants in this study reported perceptions, knowledge, or actual preparedness behaviors suggests complacency in terms of earthquake prevention, mitigation, and preparedness in particular, and, in our opinion, low general readiness for a range of hazards. The importance of focusing on human risk perceptions, decision-making, and behavior processes in preparedness is a focal point of this study. Knowledge about the differences between social groups in terms of socioeconomic characteristics such as sex and age or health status is a precursor to tapping into the cognitive, emotional, and behavioral functioning of individuals in relation to prevention, mitigation, and preparedness for earthquakes and other hazards. Thus, these findings suggest demographic profiles in which some have relative strengths. A prominent example across the categories examined is that women reported more actual behavioral preparedness whereas men reported more perceptions and knowledge. Limitations of this study include the fact that the findings presented are mainly descriptive. Future research should evaluate not only individual factors, but also social and community factors. At the same time, the sample was reasonably large and as such it offered initial basic findings that can promote more detailed future investigations. Such future research should examine the factors that affect the preparedness for earthquakes and other events, and factors improving preparedness, including more psychological (e.g., self-efficacy and behavioral intentions) and social (e.g., collective helping) constructs. Such information might then be used as a starting point to design programs to improve household preparedness for earthquakes and other hazard events. A critical issue in emergency management education and communication is how to help a population, including those with increased vulnerability, and knowing how to respond during an earthquake to protect oneself and others. One inter- 38 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 national initiative, ShakeOut (Internet 1), could be used to help people not only learn more about protecting themselves effectively during an earthquake, but also to facilitate more effective preparedness. This initiative was used to assist over fifty-five million people more effectively prepare for earthquakes in 2016. In addition, it can be used for more extensive disaster risk reduction and education in classrooms (e.g., Johnson et al. 2014) and community settings (e.g., a national effort carried out regularly in New Zealand; Internet 2). 7 References Able, E., Nelson, M. 1990: Circles of care: Work and identity in women's lives. Albany. Abolmasov, B., Jovanovski, M., Feric, P., Mihalic, M. 2011: Losses due to historical earthquakes in the Balkan region: Overview of publicly available data. Geofizika 28-1. Ainuddin, S., Routray, J. K. 2012: Institutional framework, key stakeholders and community preparedness for earthquake induced disaster management in Balochistan. Disaster Prevention and Management 21-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/09653561211202683 Ajzen, I. 1991: The theory of planned behavior. Organizational Behavior and Human Decision Processes 50-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/0749-5978(91)90020-T Ajzen, I. 2011: Theory of planned behavior. Psychology and Health 26-9. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/ 08870446.2011.613995 Antonijevic, S. K., Arroucau, P., Vlahovic, G. 2013: Seismotectonic model of the Kraljevo 3 November 2010 Mw 5.4 earthquake sequence. Seismological Research Letters 84-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1785/0220120158 Ardalan, A., Sohrabizadeh, S. 2016: Assessing households preparedness for earthquakes: an exploratory study in the development of a valid and reliable Persian-version tool. PLoS Currents 25-8. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1371/currents.dis.ccc8697279713e66887b928b839d0920 Ashida, S., Robinson, E. L., Gay, J., Slagel, L. E., Ramirez, M. R. 2017: Personal disaster and emergency support networks of older adults in a rural community: changes after participation in a preparedness program. Disaster Medicine and Public Health Preparedness 11-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1017/dmp.2016.197 Azim, M. T., Islam, M. M. 2016: Earthquake preparedness of households in Jeddah, Saudi Arabia: a perceptual study. Environmental Hazards 15-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/17477891.2016.1173006 Baker, E. J. 2011: Household preparedness for the aftermath of hurricanes in Florida. Applied Geography 31-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016Zj.apgeog.2010.05.002 Becker, J. S., Paton, D., Johnston, D. M., Ronan, K. R. 2012: A model of household preparedness for earthquakes: how individuals make meaning of earthquake information and how this influences preparedness. Natural Hazards 64-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s11069-012-0238-x Bethel, J. W., Foreman, A. N., Burke, S. C. 2011: Disaster preparedness among medically vulnerable populations. American Journal of Preventive Medicine 40-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.amepre.2010.10.020 Cvetkovic, V., Dragicevic, S., Petrovic, M., Mijakovic, S., Jakovljevic, V., Gacic, J. 2015: Knowledge and perception of secondary school students in Belgrade about earthquakes as natural disasters. Polish Journal of Environmental Studies 24-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.15244/pjoes/39702 Cvetkovic, V., Ristanovic, E., Gacic, J. 2018: Citizens attitudes about the emergency situations caused by epidemics in serbia. Iranian Journal of Public Health 47-8. DOI: https://doi.org/pmid: 30186797 Cvetkovic, V., Milasinovic, S., Lazic, 2. 2018: Examination of citizens' attitudes towards providign support to vulnerable people and voluntereeing during disasters. Journal for Social Sciences TEME 42-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.22190/TEME1801035C Devi, A. W, Sharma, D. 2015: Awareness on earthquake preparedness: A key to safe life. International Journal of Nursing Research and Practice 2-2. DeYoung, S. E., Peters, M. 2016: My community, my preparedness: The role of sense of place, community, and confidence in government in disaster readiness. International Journal of Mass Emergencies Disasters 34-2. Dooley, D., Catalano, R., Mishra, S., Serxner, S. 1992: Earthquake preparedness: Predictors in a community survey. Journal of Applied Social Psychology 22-6. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1559-1816.1992.tb00984.x Dragicevic, S., Filipovic, D., Kostadinov, S., 2ivkovic, N., Andelkovic, G., Abolmasov, B. 2011: Natural hazard assessment for land-use planning in Serbia. International Journal of Environmental Research 5-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.22059/IJER.2011.322 39 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities Duval, T. S., Mulilis, J. P. 1999: A person-relative-to-event (PrE) approach to negative threat appeals and earthquake preparedness: a field study. Journal of Applied Social Psychology 29-3. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1111/j.1559-1816.1999.tb01398.x Ersing, R. L., Alhassan, O., Ayivor, J. S., Caruson, K. 2015: Enhancing hazard resilience among impoverished urban communities in Ghana: the role of women as catalysts for improvement. Cities at Risk: Planning for and Recovering from Natural Disasters. New York. Eisenman, D. P., Wold, C., Fielding, J., Long, A., Setodji, C., Hickey, S., Gelberg, L. 2006: Differences in individual-level terrorism preparedness in Los Angeles County. American journal ofpreventive medicine 30-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.amepre.2005.09.001 FEMA, 2009: Personal preparedness in America: Findings from the Citizen Corps National Survey. Flynn, J., Slovic, P., Mertz, C. K., Carlisle, C. 1999: Public support for earthquake risk mitigation in Portland, Oregon. Risk Analysis 19-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1023/A:1006969526398 Fox, M. H., White, G. W., Rooney, C., Rowland, J. L. 2007: Disaster preparedness and response for persons with mobility impairments: results from the University of Kansas Nobody Left Behind study. Journal of Disability Policy Studies 17-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/10442073070170040201 Hackl, F., Halla, M., Pruckner, G. J. 2007: Volunteering and income-the fallacy of the good Samaritan? Kyklos 60-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1467-6435.2007.00360.x Heller, K., Alexander, D. B., Gatz, M., Knight, B. G., Rose, T. 2005: Social and personal factors as predictors of earthquake preparation: The role of support provision, network discussion, negative affect, age, and education. Journal of Applied Social Psychology 35-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1559-1816.2005.tb02127.x Hirayama, Y. 2000: Collapse and reconstruction: Housing recovery policy in Kobe after the Hanshin Great Earthquake. Housing Studies 15-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/02673030082504 Internet 1: https://www.shakeout.org/ (02. 05.2018). Internet 2: https://www.shakeout.govt.nz (02.05.2018). Jamshidi, E., Majdzadeh, R., Namin, M. S., Ardalan, A., Majdzadeh, B., Seydali, E. 2016: Effectiveness of community participation in earthquake preparedness: a community-based participatory intervention study of Tehran. Disaster Medicine and Public Health Preparedness 10-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1017/ dmp.2015.156 Johnson, B. B., Nakayachi, K. 2017: Examining associations between citizens' beliefs and attitudes about uncertainty and their earthquake risk judgments, preparedness intentions, and mitigation policy support in Japan and the United States. International Journal of Disaster Risk Reduction 22. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ijdrr.2017.02.019 Johnston, D., Becker, J., Paton, D. 2012: Multi-agency community engagement during disaster recovery: Lessons from two New Zealand earthquake events. Disaster Prevention and Management 21-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/09653561211220034 Johnson, V. A., Johnston, D. M., Ronan, K. R., Peace, R. 2014: Evaluating children's learning of adaptive response capacities from ShakeOut, an earthquake and tsunami drill in two Washington State school districts. Journal of Homeland Security and Emergency Management 11-3. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1515/jhsem-2014-0012 Joshi, A., Kale, S., Chandel, S., Pal, D. K. 2015: Likert scale: Explored and explained. British Journal of Applied Science and Technology 7-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.9734/BJAST/2015/14975 Kapucu, N. 2008: Culture of preparedness: household disaster preparedness. Disaster Prevention and Management 17-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/09653560810901773 Kirschenbaum, A. 2006: Families and disaster behavior: a reassessment of family preparedness. International Journal of Mass Emergencies and Disasters 24-1. Kirschenbaum, A. A., Rapaport, C., Canetti, D. 2017: The impact of information sources on earthquake preparedness. International Journal of Disaster Risk Reduction 21. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.ijdrr.2016.10.018 Kohn, S., Eaton, J. L., Feroz, S., Bainbridge, A. A., Hoolachan, J., Barnett, D. J. 2012: Personal disaster preparedness: an integrative review of the literature. Disaster Medicine and Public Health Preparedness 6-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1001/dmp.2012.47 Komac, B., Zorn, M., Gavrilov, B., Markovic, S. 2013: Natural hazards - some introductory thoughts. Acta geographica Slovenica 53-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS53300 40 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Levac, J., Toal-Sullivan, D., O'Sullivan, T. L. 2012: Household emergency preparedness: a literature review. Journal of Community Health 37-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s10900-011-9488-x Lindell, M. K., Perry, R. W 2000: Household adjustment to earthquake hazard: A review of research. Environment and Behavior 32-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/00139160021972621 Liu, Q., Ruan, X., Shi, P. 2011: Selection of emergency shelter sites for seismic disasters in mountainous regions: Lessons from the 2008 Wenchuan Ms 8.0 Earthquake, China. Journal of Asian Earth Sciences 40-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016Zj.jseaes.2010.07.014 Lukic, T., Gavrilov, M. B., Markovic, S. B., Zorn, M., Komac, B., Mladjan, D., Djordjevic, J., Milanovic, M., Vasiljevic, D. A., Vujicic, M. D., Kuzmanovic, B., Prentovic, R. 2013: Classification of the natural disasters between the legislation and application: experience of the Republic of Serbia. Acta geographica Slovenica 53-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS53301 Maddux, J. E., Rogers, R. W 1983: Protection motivation and self-efficacy: A revised theory of fear appeals and attitude change. Journal of Experimental Social Psychology 19-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ 0022-1031(83)90023-9 Marovic, M., Djokovic, I., Pesic, L., Radovanovic, S., Toljic, M., Gerzina, N. 2002: Neotectonics and seismicity of the southern margin of the Pannonian basin in Serbia. EGU Stephan Mueller Special Publication Series 3. Marti, M., Stauffacher, M., Matthes, J., Wiemer, S. 2018: Communicating earthquake preparedness: the influence of induced mood, perceived risk, and gain or loss frames on homeowners' attitudes toward general precautionary measures for earthquakes. Risk Analysis 38-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1111/risa. 12875 Matsuda, Y., Okada, N. 2006: Community diagnosis for sustainable disaster preparedness. Journal of Natural Disaster Science 28-1. Mileti, D. S., Darlington, J. D. 1997: The role of searching in shaping reactions to earthquake risk information. Social Problems 44-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.2307/3096875 Mishra, S., Suar, D. 2012: Effects of anxiety, disaster education, and resources on disaster preparedness behavior. Journal of Applied Social Psychology 42-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1559-1816.2011.00853.x Mulilis, J. P., Duval, T. S., Lippa, R. 1990: The effects of a large destructive local earthquake on earthquake preparedness as assessed by an earthquake preparedness scale. Natural Hazards 3-4. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1007/BF00124393 Mulilis, J. P., Lippa, R. 1990: Behavioral change in earthquake preparedness due to negative threat appeals: A test of protection motivation theory. Journal of Applied Social Psychology 20-8. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1111/j.1559-1816.1990.tb00429.x Murphy, S. T., Cody, M., Frank, L. B., Glik, D., Ang, A. 2009: Predictors of emergency preparedness and compliance. Disaster Medicine and Public Health Preparedness 3-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1097/ dmp. 0b013e3181 a9c6c5 Muttarak, R., Pothisiri, W 2013: The role of education on disaster preparedness: case study of 2012 Indian Ocean earthquakes on Thailand's Andaman Coast. Ecology and Society 18-4. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.5751/es-06101-180451 Norris, F. H., Friedman, M. J., Watson, P. J., Byrne, C. M., Diaz, E., Kaniasty, K. 2002: 60,000 disaster victims speak: Part I. An empirical review of the empirical literature, 1981-2001. Psychiatry: Interpersonal and biological processes 65-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1521/psyc.65.3.207.20173 Page, L., Rubin, J., Amlót, R., Simpson, J., Wessely, S. 2008: Are Londoners prepared for an emergency? A longitudinal study following the London bombings. Biosecurity and Bioterrorism: Biodefense Strategy, Practice, and Science 6-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1089/bsp.2008.0043 Panic, M., Kovacevic-Majkic, J., Miljanovic, D., Miletic, R. 2013: Importance of natural disaster education-case study of the earthquake near the city of Kraljevo: First results. Journal of the Geographical Institute »Jovan Cvijic« SASA 63-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.2298/IJGI121121001P Paton, D. 2003: Disaster preparedness: a social-cognitive perspective. Disaster Prevention and Management 12-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/09653560310480686 Paton, D., Anderson, E., Becker, J., Petersen, J. 2015: Developing a comprehensive model of hazard preparedness: lessons from the Christchurch earthquake. International Journal of Disaster Risk Reduction 14. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ijdrr.2014.11.011 41 Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities Paton, D., Sagala, S., Okada, N., Jang, L. J., Bürgelt, P. T., Gregg, C. E. 2010: Making sense of natural hazard mitigation: Personal, social and cultural influences. Environmental Hazards 9-2. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.3763/ehaz.2010.0039 Paul, B. K., Bhuiyan, R. H. 2010: Urban earthquake hazard: Perceived seismic risk and preparedness in Dhaka City, Bangladesh. Disasters 34-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1467-7717.2009.01132.x Pešic, J. 2006: Persistence of traditionalist value orientations in Serbia. Sociologija 48-4. Ronan, K., Johnston, D. 2005: Promoting Community Resilience in Disasters: The Role for Schools, Youth, and Families. Boston. Ronan, R., Johnston, M. 2005: Promoting community resilience in disasters. New York. Rossi, P. P. H. 1990: Of human bonding: Parent-child relations across the life course. Hawthorne. Russell, L. A., Goltz, J. D., Bourque, L. B. 1995: Preparedness and hazard mitigation actions before and after two earthquakes. Environment and Behavior 27-6. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/0013916595276002 Rüstemli, A., Karanci, A. N. 1999: Correlates of earthquake cognitions and preparedness behavior in a victimized population. The Journal of Social Psychology 139-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/00224549909598364 Sattler, D. N., Kaiser, C. F., Hittner, J. B. 2000: Disaster preparedness: Relationships among prior experience, personal characteristics, and distress. Journal of Applied Social Psychology 30-7. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1111/j.1559-1816.2000.tb02527.x Shaw, R., Shiwaku, K., Kobayashi, H., Kobayashi, M. 2004: Linking experience, knowledge, perception and earthquake preparedness. Disaster Prevention and Management 13-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/ 09653560410521689 Solberg, C., Rossetto, T., Joffe, H. 2010: The social psychology of seismic hazard adjustment: re-evaluating the international literature. Natural Hazards and Earth System Sciences 10-8. DOI: https://doi.org/10.5194/ nhess-10-1663-2010 Spittal, J., McClure, J., Siegert, J., Walkey, H. 2008: Predictors of two types of earthquake preparation: survival activities and mitigation activities. Environment and Behavior 40-6. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/ 0013916507309864 Spittal, M. J., Walkey, F. H., McClure, J., Siegert, R. J., Ballantyne, K. E. 2006: The earthquake readiness scale: The development of a valid and reliable unifactorial measure. Natural Hazards 39-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s11069-005-2369-9 Tanida, N. 1996: What happened to elderly people in the great Hanshin earthquake. British Medical Journal 313-70. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1136/bmj.313.7065.1133 Tomio, J., Sato, H., Matsuda, Y., Koga, T., Mizumura, H. 2014: Household and community disaster preparedness in Japanese provincial city: a population-based household survey. Advances in Anthropology 4-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.4236/aa.2014.42010 Vukasinovic, M. 1987: Seizmološka mapa Srbije za povratni period od 100 godina. Belgrade. WHO, 2008. Manual for the Health Care of Children in Humanitarian Emergencies. World Heath Organization. Geneva. Woersching, J. C., Snyder, A. E. 2003: Earthquakes in El Salvador: a descriptive study of health concerns in a rural community and the clinical implications, part I. Disaster Management Response 1-4. Zorn, M. 2018: Natural disasters and less developed countries. Nature, Tourism and Ethnicity as Drivers of (De)Marginalization. Perspectives on Geographical Marginality 3. Cham. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/ 978-3-319-59002-8_4 Zorn, M., Komac, B. 2015: Naravne nesreče in družbena neodgovornost. Geografski vestnik 87-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/GV87205 42 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 43-42 SPATIAL CONFLICTS: ANALYZING A BURDEN CREATED BY DIFFERING LAND USE Iwona Cieslak Land use in the typical landscape of Warmia and Mazury in Poland. Iwona Cieslak, Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.5181 UDC: 711:711.14(438) COBISS: 1.01 Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use ABSTRACT: The article proposes a procedure for determining the location of potential spatial conflicts. The author presents issues concerning spatial conflicts which may arise as a result of different uses of spaces adjacent to each other. The proposed procedure has been tested on one of the districts of Poland's Warminsko-Mazurskie Voivodeship, namely Nidzicki District. In order to determine the use of the space, CLC databases made available by the Chief Environmental Protection Inspectorate were used. Based on them, the use of fragments of space, which were also differentiated due to their natural value, was determined. For the thus described space, a map of burden of potential spatial conflicts was compiled. The proposed method may be used as a tool supporting the processes of space planning and monitoring the environmental changes. KEY WORDS: spatial planning, spatial structure, spatial conflicts, uses of spaces, CLC, natural value Prostorski konflikti: Analiza bremena, ki nastane zaradi različne rabe prostora POVZETEK: V članku avtorica predlaga postopek za določanje lokacije morebitnih prostorskih konfliktov. Predstavi vprašanja, povezana s prostorskimi konflikti, ki lahko nastanejo zaradi različne rabe sosednjih prostorov. Predlagani postopek je avtorica preizkusila na primeru okrožja Nidzica v Varminsko-mazurskem vojvodstvu na Poljskem. Za določitev rabe prostora je uporabila podatke CLC (Corine Land Cover), ki jih je pridobila od glavnega poljskega okoljevarstvenega inšpektorata. Na podlagi teh podatkov je določila rabo posameznih delov proučevanega prostora, ki jih je ločila tudi glede na njihovo naravno vrednost. Za tako analizirani prostor je sestavila zemljevid bremen morebitnih prostorskih konfliktov. Predlagana metoda se lahko uporablja kot podporno orodje pri postopkih prostorskega načrtovanja in spremljanja okoljskih sprememb. KLJUČNE BESEDE: prostorsko načrtovanje, prostorska zgradba, prostorski konflikti, raba prostora, CLC, naravna vrednost Iwona Cieslak Faculty of Geodesy, Geospatial and Civil Engineering, University of Warmia and Mazury in Olsztyn isidor@uwm.edu.pl The paper was submitted for publication on August 21st, 2017. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 21. avgusta 2017. 44 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction Conflicts are a common phenomenon which always occurs between at least two entities, of which one strives to achieve benefits for themselves at the expense of the other party without its approval (Braun and Wimmer 2013). The notion of a conflict can be seen in various aspects, e.g. as a social, economic process in which one of the entities strives to achieve their own goals by either eliminating the other party of the conflict or establishing own domination over it. It should be noted that the above contradiction does not have to be real, and may result from the involved parties' conviction that the other party displays a hostile attitude (Kieslich and Hilbig 2014). A conflict cannot exist if certain conditions distinguishing it from normal competition having no negative overtone are not satisfied. These conditions include: • The existence of at least two parties; • The main source of a conflict is the scarcity of goods; • Conflict behaviour is aimed at either destroying the other party or at least establishing domination over it; • Actions of the parties of a conflict are mutually opposed; • An important aspect of conflict relationships is power; • Conflict relationships are a social process, and have serious social consequences; • Conflicts are characterised by a temporary tendency towards a split in relationships between the parties; • Conflict relationships result in a change to expectations and standards prevailing in the existing system (Mack and Snyder 1957). The first five of the above eight conditions are considered by the authors to be the main characteristics of the phenomenon in question. In order to identify both the existing and possible future conflicts, it is crucial to determine potential sources of conflicts. Their basic categories were systematised by Bogetoft and Pruzan (1991). These authors conclude that conflicts may arise from one or several various factors which can be divided into four basic groups: 1 »Value system« factors: • The parties have different values and aims; • The parties take different measures to represent their aims; • The parties have different preference hierarchies (e.g. different weights for different solutions). 2 »Effect distribution« factors: • The parties may incur different costs and achieve various indirect benefits associated with the expected effects of actions; • Breakdown of costs and benefits is perceived as uneven and unfair. 3 »Uncertainty« factors: • The parties do not agree to the probable effects of an action; • The parties are not certain of the effects of actions; • The evidence and rationale as regards the benefits of the effects of actions may be insufficient or incomprehensible; • The parties may have doubts about the relations between the effects of an action and different actions. 4 »Process« factors: • The parties have difficulties in communicating with one another in terms of presenting one's values, aims, criteria, preferences, and expectations. All these factors have a common denominator which is manifested by the contradictory actions of the entities, with each action located in the space. A significant percentage of conflict subjects are directly or indirectly associated with the space. The conflicts in which this relationship is direct are referred to as spatial conflicts. In terms of theoretical bases, spatial conflicts do not differ from the general concept of this phenomenon. They only set out the subject of a conflict, which always is the space. Usually, a source of spatial conflicts is the occurrence, within a particular area, of many different possibilities for the management and/or many various interests and aims, also those associated with the use of environmental goods (Wehrmann 2008; Bob and Bronkhorst 2011). Given the subject, spatial conflicts are of interest to spatial economy, including spatial planning (Bergstrom, Goetz and Shortle 2013). Spatial planning is a complex process. In most cases, it is associated with numerous expectations, high uncertainty level, and always a certain degree of a conflict (Alston, Libecap 45 Iwona Cieslak, Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use and Mueller 1999). Therefore, understanding the expectations, uncertainties and conflicts is necessary to reflect upon the way to improve the current planning practices (Domingo 2009; Nolon, Ferguson and Field 2013). The planning process is usually perceived as less important than the development process (Smrekar, Hribar and Erhartic 2016). It should be borne in mind, however, that the role of a plan may be perceived as a »meeting point« for various, sometimes contradictory views, and as a framework for taking joint decisions (Hopkins 2001). Therefore, it is extremely important to identify potential spatial conflicts as early as at the planning stage. Minimisation of the probability of their occurrence leads to achieving sustainable development (Markuszewska 2018). The main conflicts in achieving such development exhibit functional and economic, socio-cultural, or natural and ecological characteristics (Abdelgalil and Cohen 2007). Functional and economic conflicts result from the simultaneous occurrence of factors focusing and defocusing various functions of the space, which may lead to imbalance in the management (Glasson and Marshall 2007; De Groot 2006). They are usually associated with a significant disproportion in the development of adjacent areas, and thus tendencies towards excessive concentration (e.g. in towns and cities), and, at the same time, the establishment of peripheral, underdeveloped areas (Coppens 2011). Social and cultural conflicts are associated with contradictory aspirations of managing entities as regards the use of the space (Hite 1998; Brown and Raymond 2014). Most often, these are conflicts associated with the existence or development of infrastructure, with opposition from local communities to unfavourable changes in their immediate vicinity (von der Dunk et al. 2011). A conflict situation may also arise from an opposite situation e.g. when local communities aim at the expansion of a certain type of infrastructure, and supra-local social groups benefiting from the use of the space in the existing state oppose to these aims. A typical example of spatial conflicts are natural and environmental conflicts arising from the clash of the need for economic development and the necessity to protect the values of the natural environment (Young et al. 2005; Kennedy 2017). Such a division of conflicts is neither closed nor sharp. In many cases, these conflicts have characteristics of various groups listed in this paper. They are both social and economic conflicts, etc. (Braun and Wimmer 2013). As has been emphasised, spatial conflicts are associated with a specific use of the space, and frequently arise from nothing else but the use of the space, or from the desire to change its use. At the stage of planning the management of the space, it is very important to recognise the fragments of the space where the probability of the occurrence of conflicts may be high (Bilozor and Renigier-Bilozor 2015). One of the factors to be analysed while searching for such spaces is an analysis of the variety of uses, and the identification of extremely different forms of the use of adjacent areas. One of the stages in the procedure for determining the interaction of areas with different forms of use is to refer to their natural value. There are several methods for carrying out such an assessment. It may be carried out by expert research conducted directly in the field inventory of the area through field-work (Leedy and Ormrod 2005; Hrvatin and Perko 2008), or in-house inventory based on existing documentation of the land (Strumillo-Rembowska, Bednarczyk and Cieslak 2014) or its aerial and satellite photographs (Joshi, de Leeuw and van Duren 2004). This is the most precise yet very laborious method, which is worth to follow for the purposes requiring research of great precision, carried out within a small area. Expert research may also concern the model of land i.e. maps and related documentation, providing knowledge of the value of the area. The assessment is based on in-house inventory of the area based on the existing documents (Figure 1). One of the ways to determine such a value is to use the existing soil valuation assessments of the natural value of an area, associated with its uses. This method is definitely less precise yet sufficient for achieving many research objectives, including those associated with spatial planning. Moreover, it provides a possibility for conducting analyses to people who are not experts in biological sciences. An important stage of the analysis is to determine the relationships between adjacent areas, from which spatial conflicts may arise. These relationships may be determined using a description. However, for the needs of statistical analyses, and in order to simplify the inference process, the desired form is a numerical form. A reference to the steps described can be found in Figure 1. The main objective of the research presented in the paper was to establish a procedure for identifying areas with high potential for spatial conflicts, referred to as land's burden. An important step in the work was the verification of the proposed procedure with the selected area as an example. 46 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 2 Methods Monitoring the use of the space and the changes of occurring in this is became easier when spatial information bases began to be established. CLC (CORINE Land Cover) belongs to one of such bases. The CORINE project (CO-ordinate of Information on Environment - Land Cover) was launched on the initiative ofthe European Community in 1985. In 2001, Chief Environmental Protection Inspector decided to incorporate Poland into the project (Cieslak, Szuniewicz and Czyza 2016; Corine Land Cover 2018). The established database contains information on both the land cover and the land use. In the CLC, forms of land cover are hierarchically divided into three levels (Ciolkosz and Bielecka 2005). According to the CLC legend, five basic forms of land cover are distinguished (Table 1). Table 1: Detailed expansion of land use forms in CLC (Internet). LEVEL I Description LEVEL II 1 ARTIFICIAL SURFACES Built-up areas used for residential, service, industrial or mining purposes, and green urban areas 1.1 Urban fabric 1.2 Industrial, commercial and transport units 1.3 Mine, dump and construction sites 1.4 Artificial, non-agricultural vegetated areas 2 AGRICULTURAL AREAS Agricultural areas, permanent crops, meadows and pasture land as well as wooded land and bushland used for agricultural purposes 2.1 Arable land 2.2 Permanent crops 2.3 Pastures 2.4 Heterogeneous agricultural areas 3 FOREST AND SEMI-NATURAL AREAS Areas covered with forest vegetation, or partially deprived thereof 3.1 Forests 3.2 Scrub and/or herbaceous associations 3.3 Open spaces with little or no vegetation 4 WETLANDS Inland bogs, peatbogs, salt marshes, salines, and tidal marshes 4.1 Inland wetlands 4.2 Marine wetlands 5 WATER BODIES Inland waters and marine waters 5.1 Inland waters 5.2 Marine waters This paper uses data with the degree of generalisation to the 2nd CLC level. The data provided a basis for land with specific use within the area under study. The main objective of the study was to establish a load factor for conflicting areas. The developed indicator was made dependent on the natural values of adjacent areas with different uses. The identification of areas with high potential for spatial conflicts was defined in the procedure whose diagram is provided in Figure 1. The first stage of the procedure is to establish the limits of various forms of land use. This stage can be passed through using several methods. The most obvious appear to be field inventory, analysis of formal and legal documentation, and the use of currently broadly developed Geographical Information System databases. One of such bases is the CLC. The second stage of research work required the differentiation of the natural values of areas with different uses. Compensation indicators which are used in the Federal Republic of Germany to determine the amounts of compensation for changes to the space use, were applied (NatSchAVO 1995). As part ofthe Saxony's environmental protection law, a compensation procedure aimed at both stopping the pointless degradation of the environment and ensuring high natural quality of the space was developed (SMUL 2009). As part of that procedure, on the basis of research into biodiversity and physical characteristics of the space, a scale of land assessment, assigned to specific forms of its cover, was developed (Cieslak, Szuniewicz and Gerus-Gosciewska 2013). It organises the quality of an area based on the natural value, and specifies differences or proportions between the values of areas with different uses. The indicator (ix) taken from the planning system of Saxony, marked for the needs of the study as ix, are a simplified assessment of the quality of natural environment which result from the use of that space. The assessment in question (Table 2) may be useful while preparing a simplified assessment of the environmental value of the space; however, it should be borne in mind that it is based on a very simplistic approach, and its results are only illustrative. 47 Iwona Cieslak, Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use Figure 1: Two different concepts in analysing and procedure for the determination of the burden of potential conflicts within the space under study. Table 2: The value of the environmental coefficient. Category of land Land use Coefficient ix CLC AO Built-up area, impervious to water (roads, buildings, paved areas) 0.10 1.1; 1.2; 1.3 A1 Permeable surfaces, areas of greenery around buildings 0.10 - - A2 Areas of greenery in residential quarters, allotments, orchards, greens 0.20 1.4 A3 Intensively cultivated agricultural land (arable land) 0.30 2.1 A4 Other intensively used areas (orchard plantations) 0.40 2.3; 2.4 A5 Watercourses and standing waters with a poor natural structure (regulated watercourses, fish farming ponds), including riparian and shallow-water vegetation and open spaces with little or no vegetation 0.50 2.3; 3.3 A6 Forest areas with an unnatural tree species composition, shrub vegetation communities 0.60 3.2 A7 Extensive land use areas (e.g. extensive grassland, extensive vineyards, areas which can be intensively cultivated in the long term), or succession areas 0.70 2.2 A8 Forest areas with a natural tree, forests on an open space, green areas with old trees, parks, pedestrian pathways, single trees 0.80 3.1 A9 Flowing and standing waters with a rich natural structure 0.90 5.1; 5.2. 4.1; 4.2 A1O A biotope as defined by environmental protection regulations (National Parks, nature reserves) 1.00 - 48 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 However, the use of such a grading scale may provide a basis for determining the location of many spatial phenomena, including the location of potential spatial conflicts (Cieslak 2012). The assessment presented in Table 2 was transformed to include the forms of land cover available at the 2nd level of the CLC database (Cieslak et al. 2017).It was necessary to supplement both lists so that all forms of land cover could be evaluated during the analysis. Protected areas are not included in the CLC inventoried forms of land cover. Such an inventory is not possible with the use of an orthophotomap on which the CLC is based. The 3rd stage of research work required the determination of relationships between adjacent areas, which could indicate an adverse interaction. For the purposes of the study, a conflict matrix was developed (Figure 2), which presents theoretical intensity of the contradiction in the use of a space marked as P0Kp. This contradiction may determine the occurrence of spatial conflicts for adjacent areas. The value of the indicator was calculated as a ratio of ix of a lower value to ix of a higher value for adjacent fields. Conditions for the calculation of particular matrix values are provided in the following equation: If iXi < ixn then Pgpn = ^ If iXi > ixn then P$pn = ^ IXji where: - an indicator of the intensity of a potential conflict between areas i and n, ix( - value of ix for field i, ix - value of ix for field n. n The conflict matrix is a symmetric matrix. The indicator values presented in the matrix may range from 1.00 to 10.00. At a value of 1.00, the burden of a potential conflict does not, in principle, exist. When P0Kp is equal to 10.00, the neighbourhood of an area is extremely contradictory to its natural value, which may generate spatial conflicts. The developed matrix is a theoretical matrix which can be used universally. In the presented study, the values of P0^ indicator may only range from 1.00 to 9.00. This results from no possibility of identification based on the CLC data concerning protected areas with ix equal to 1.00. The values found in the matrix were divided into three classes of intensity of potential conflicts. The first class comprises areas for which the mutual neighbourhood results in a hazard of the occurrence of spatial conflicts at a minimum level (values ranging from 1.00 to 1.50). The second class of values was determined for areas with a medium level of the hazard of the occurrence of conflicts due to their mutual neighbourhood (values ranging from 1.60 to 3.50). The third class was determined for the values with high probability of the occurrence of spatial conflicts due to the extremely different natural values of the adjacent areas (values ranging from 4.00 to 10.00). Based on the conflict matrix, real values of the burden of occurrence of spatial conflicts were determined, which, in addition to the immediate neighbourhood of areas with different uses, takes their surface into account. P^. for a selected area i is equal to the ratio of the sum of products of the surface of N areas adjacent to it, and the product of indicators ix consistent with the form of use of area i and areas n, to the total surface of areas n adjacent to i: ZN nO n _ 71=1 rKpn rn "Kpi ~ yN D ¿in=l rn where: - external burden of a spatial conflict; i - the area of use under study; n - the number of the area adjacent to area i; N - number of the areas of use adjacent to area i; Pn - the surface of the n-th area adjacent to area i; ix - indicator of the natural value of area i or n. Figure 2: The conflict matrix of the contradiction in the use of a space. p p. 50 49 ix 1.00 0.90 0.90 0.80 0.80 0.70 0.60 0.50 0.40 0.40 0.40 0.30 0.20 0.10 0.09 0.09 de 6,0 5,2 5,1 4,2 4,1 3,1 3,2 3,3 2,4 2,3 2,2 2,1 1,4 1,3 1,2 1,1 1.00 6,0 1.00 1.11 1.11 1.25 1.25 1.43 1.67 2.00 2.50 2.50 2.50 3.33 5.00 10.00 10.00 10.00 0.90 5,2 1.11 1.00 1.00 1.13 1.13 1.29 1.50 1.80 2.25 2.25 2.25 3.00 4.50 9.00 10.00 10.00 0.90 5,1 1.11 1.00 1.00 1.13 1.13 1.29 1.50 1.80 2.25 2.25 2.25 3.00 4.50 9.00 10.00 10.00 0.80 4,2 1.25 1.13 1.13 1.00 1.00 1.14 1.33 1.60 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.67 4.00 8.00 8.89 8.89 0.80 4,1 1.25 1.13 1.13 1.00 1.00 1.14 1.33 1.60 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.67 4.00 8.00 8.89 8.89 0.70 3,1 1.43 1.29 1.29 1.14 1.14 1.00 1.17 1.40 1.75 1.75 1.75 2.33 3.50 7.00 7.78 7.78 0.60 3,2 1.67 1.50 1.50 1.33 1.33 1.17 1.00 1.20 1.50 1.50 1.50 2.00 3.00 6.00 6.67 6.67 0.50 3,3 2.00 1.80 1.80 1.60 1.60 1.40 1.20 1.00 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.67 2.50 5.00 5.56 5.56 0.40 2,4 2.50 2.25 2.25 2.00 2.00 1.75 1.50 1.25 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.33 2.00 4.00 4.44 4.44 0.40 2,3 2.50 2.25 2.25 2.00 2.00 1.75 1.50 1.25 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.33 2.00 4.00 4.44 4.44 0.40 2,2 2.50 2.25 2.25 2.00 2.00 1.75 1.50 1.25 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.33 2.00 4.00 4.44 4.44 0.30 2,1 3.33 3.00 3.00 2.67 2.67 2.33 2.00 1.67 1.33 1.33 1.33 1.00 1.50 3.00 3.33 3.33 0.20 1,4 5.00 4.50 4.50 4.00 4.00 3.50 3.00 2.50 2.00 2.00 2.00 1.50 1.00 2.00 2.22 2.22 0.10 1,3 10.00 9.00 9.00 8.00 8.00 7.00 6.00 5.00 4.00 4.00 4.00 3.00 2.00 1.00 1.11 1.11 0.10 1,2 10.00 10.00 10.00 8.89 8.89 7.78 6.67 5.56 4.44 4.44 4.44 3.33 2.22 1.11 1.00 1.00 0.10 1,1 10.00 10.00 10.00 8.89 8.89 7.78 6.67 5.56 4.44 4.44 4.44 3.33 2.22 1.11 1.00 1.00 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 An example ofthe arrangement of adjacent fields is presented in Figure 3. The Figure is linked to Table 3. The Table also contains subsequent calculations which enable the determination of the final value PKj for field No 7 (i = 7), and for field No 324 (i = 324) (Figure 3). Figure 3: An example of the adjacency defined for fields No 7 and 324. Table 3: An example of the calculation of the value PK for fields No 7 and 324 (Figure 3). 1V N ' lxi N n ixn Pn P0 r Kpn P0 * P r Kpn n y , Pkpn ' ¡n 71=1 I'» n=1 P Kpi 7 0.6 6 4 0.8 30.80 1.33 41.07 695.75 239.76 2.90 18 0.3 17.08 2.00 34.16 83 0.4 63.49 6.00 380.94 309 0.4 27.11 1.50 40.67 315 0.5 58.29 1.20 69.95 324 0.3 42.99 3.00 128.97 324 0.5 4 7 0.6 56.24 3.00 168.72 419.36 168.75 2.48 18 0.3 17.08 1.50 25.62 25 0.5 68.32 2.50 170.80 309 0.4 27.11 2.00 54.22 In this way determined indicator indicates the intensity of contradiction in the use of adjacent areas. If these are areas of high natural values, the impact of adjacent areas with more intense pattern of use needs to be mitigated. The procedure described was tested within the area of Nidzicki District situated in Warminsko-Mazurskie Voivodeship. The district covers an area of 961 km2. This is a very interesting area as in addition to its significant natural values, it is a rapidly developing administrative unit of the voivodeship. ArcGis software tools were used to complete the calculation stages, and to present the analysis results. 3 Results The Nidzicki District belongs to the Mazurian Lake District. The area is characterised by a hilly landscape with numerous post-glacial lakes, and heavily wooded. Because of the natural and cultural assets, many nature reserves and landscape parks have been established within the district. On the other hand, the district 51 Iwona Cieslak, Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use has many attributes conducive to the development of the economy. The area is very well connected internally. Economic entities operate there in the trade, service, and manufacturing sectors, yet it is agriculture that is the main branch of the economy. Due to the natural and economic determinants, the spatial structure of the district is very varied, and susceptible to spatial conflicts. In accordance with the proposed procedure, 411 areas with various uses consistent with the 2nd CLC level were identified within the district. Their area varies from 0.25 m2 to 4327.31 m2. Based on the analysis of the cover of these areas, natural values ix were assigned to them in accordance with the rule provided in Table 2. Even though the area under study includes protected areas, it was possible to assign the maximum value of 0.9 to them based on the forms of land cover identified using the CLC. The results of this operation are presented in a chorogram (Figure 4). The chorogram indicates intensely used locations (shades of red) indicate those used by humans, which are mainly located in the urbanised space. It can also be noted that within the area under study, many naturally valuable areas are located (shades of green). In the next step, for each of 411 areas marked as i, areas which are directly adjacent to them were identified (n). Based on the data, indicator PKp was calculated for each area. This indicator illustrates the area's burden of potential spatial conflicts resulting from different uses of the adjacent areas, with account taken of their surface. The value of indicator PK within the area under study ranged from 1.00 to 8.00. An average value for the area is 2.07 at a standard deviation of 1.14. The values of the indicator were classified in accordance with the procedure presented in the Methods. The thus calculated area's burden of the occurrence of conflicts for all fields enabled the development of a chorogram of the potential occurrence of spatial conflicts for the area under study (Figure 5). An analysis of the chorogram provides a possibility for the identification of areas with high potential for spatial conflicts (3rd class) as well as areas for which such a hazard does not exist (1st class). For 411 analysed areas, the indicator values were ranging from 1.00 to 8.00. They were divided into three classes in accordance with the adopted procedure described in section 2. In class 1, for which the burden of conflict is not significant, 127 areas are included. 79 of them are such areas for which the values of indicator ix took values of 0.4, 0.5, and 0.6. Therefore, their natural value is average. For 48 areas of this class, indicator ix is very high (0.8, 0.9). In the second class, 272 areas are included. In this class, the differentiation of the natural value was high. The areas were described by indicator ix within a range from 0.1 to 0.9. The smallest class in terms of numbers was the third class including only 13 areas. An interesting fact is that all of them have a relatively small surface area, and a very low natural value. All of them are described with indicator ix having a value of 0.1. 4 Discussion While pursuing the main aim of the research, which was to establish a procedure for identifying areas with high potential for spatial conflicts, referred to as land's burden, a study was conducted, which enabled the establishment of a procedure for identification of the location of potential spatial conflicts resulting from the proximity of different forms of space use. To this end, the index of external burden of a spatial conflict PKp was determined.The obtained results confirm that the CLC can be used to identify potential spatial conflicts resulting from the immediate vicinity of areas with adverse impact. An important advantage of these data is their universal nature. These data have a uniform structure and present large areas. This makes the analysis results comparable for various areas and on variety of scales. However, their significant disadvantage is their low validity (the latest data are for 2012), and limitations resulting from the method of obtaining these data (orthophotomaps). While using such results it should be borne in mind, that the databases obtained based on satellite images do not contain information on the legal aspects of land use. Therefore, the obtained results cannot indicate conflicts concerning areas which are e.g. legally protected. We can conclude that the space in question is relatively well used. This is evidenced by the average value of indicator PKp obtained for the entire area (2.07), and its standard deviation (1.14). Within the district, Figure 4: Chorogram with various indicators of the natural value ix for the area under study. p p. 53 Figure 5: Chorogram of the potential occurrence of spatial conflicts for the area under study. p p. 54 52 Legend C3 district boundary Coefficient ix I I 0.1 ■ 0.2 I I 0-3 I I 0-4 I I 0-5 | 0.6 ■ 0.8 ■ 0.9 Scale: 1:300 000 Content by: Iwona Cieslak Map by: Iwona Cieslak Source: CODGiK Poland © 2017, UWM Olsztyn Legend C3 district boundary Indicator classes Pkp | I 1st class 1.00-1.50 | | 2nd class 1.60-3.50 3rd class 3.60-10.00 0 1 2 4 6 8 Scale: 1:300 000 Content by: Iwona Cieslak Map by: Iwona Cieslak Source: CODGiK Poland © 2017, UWM Olsztyn Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 there are not many places for which the probability of the occurrence of a spatial conflict due to extremely different forms of use of adjacent spaces is very high. For most of the area under study, the burden of the occurrence of conflicts is heightened yet not very high (the second class). An interesting result concerns locations of spatial conflicts. They are only formed in proximity to very intensely used areas (a natural indicator for the third class of the external burden of spatial conflicts amounts to 0.1 for all areas). It follows that such areas appear frequently in the immediate neighborhood of naturally valuable areas. The indication of such places enables the location of areas in need of special attention, which should be permanently monitored. The developed procedure for the determination of indicator PKp is an useful tool supporting of spatial planning, and for monitoring the implementation of the assumptions outlined in the process. 5 Conclusion In accordance with the established and described procedure, it was found that the most efficient method for obtaining data on the diversity of uses of the district land was the use of the existing spatial databases. This is a method that does not require a lot of work and time, which determines its high level of efficiency. However, the conducted study proves that based on monitoring the forms of land cover, it is possible to determine the location of potential conflicts resulting from their inadequate neighbourhood. This provides an opportunity for the identification of areas for which a thorough and in-depth analysis should be conducted in order to identify the adverse impact of neighbouring areas. This confirms the need for maintaining such databases, their updating and integration with other geoinformation databases. Results of the conducted analysis demonstrated that within the analysed space there is a risk of the occurrence of spatial conflicts, mainly due to the immediate neighbourhood of areas intensely used by humans and naturally valuable areas. The indication of the location of areas for which this neighbourhood may be particularly controversial can become an important element of preventing conflicts through improving the spatial planning process. The proposed method for identifying areas with high potential for spatial conflicts is a novel approach in the description of the phenomenon of conflicts. It is based on the values of indices which are a good carrier of information on the phenomena occurring within the space. Not only do they provide an opportunity to identify places with an elevated risk of the emergence of conflicts but also to dynamically monitor such phenomena. However, the access to spatial data may become a threat to such an approach. The data used in the described research are rarely updated. What is more, geodatabases are characterised by a low level of homogeneity. For various spaces, they are collected and described in a different way. However, it is necessary to take into account the development of methods for collecting and processing data, which will certainly contribute to an improvement of this situation, thus providing an opportunity to deepen and improve the established procedure. The rate of spatial phenomena requires that tools for identifying adverse events within a space, to which spatial conflicts certainly belong, should be developed. The proposed procedure may certainly be modified depending on the objective of analyses, the nature of the area under study, and the access to spatial data bases. On the other hand, it can be a tool supporting the processes of planning and monitoring sustainable development of the space. 6 References Abdelgalil, E. A., Cohen, S. I. 2007: Economic development and resource degradation: Conflicts and policies. Socio-Economic Planning Sciences 41-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016Zj.seps.2005.10.002 Alston, L. J., Libecap, G. D., Mueller, B. 1999: Titles, conflict, and land use: The development ofproperty rights and land reform on the Brazilian Amazon frontier. Ann Arbor. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3998/mpub.16208 Bergstrom, J. C., Goetz, S. J., Shortle, J. S. (eds.) 2013: Land use problems and conflicts: Causes, consequences and solutions. London, New York. 55 Iwona Cieslak, Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use Bilozor A., Renigier-Bilozor M. 2015: Optimization and polyoptimization in the management of land. Proceedings of the SGEM 2015 GeoConference on Informatics, geoinformatics and remote sensing. Albena. Bob, U., Bronkhorst, S. 2011: Environmental conflicts: Key issues and management implications. African Journal on Conflict Resolution, 10-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.4314/ajcr.v10i2.63307 Bogetoft, P., Pruzan, P. 1991: Planning with Multiple Criteria: Investigation, Communication. Copenhagen. Brown, G., Raymond, C. M. 2014: Methods for identifying land use conflict potential using participatory mapping. Landscape and Urban Planning 122. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016Zj.landurbplan.2013.11.007 Braun, S.,Wimmer, A. 2013: Civil Society Conflicts Environment & Social Conflicts. SSRN Electronic Journal. DOI: https://doi.org/10.2139/ssrn.2655023 Cieslak, I., Szuniewicz, K., Czyza, S. 2016: Analysis of the Variation of the Areas Under Urbanization Pressure Using Entropy Index. Procedia Engineering 161. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.proeng.2016.08.793 Cieslak I., Szuniewicz K., Gerus-Gosciewska M. 2013: Evaluation of the Natural Value of Land Before and after Planning Procedures. Rural Development 6-3. Cieslak, I. (ed.) 2012: Wspólczesna waloryzacja przestrzeni zurbanizowanej. Olsztyn. Cieslak, I., Szuniewicz K., Pawlewicz K., Czyza S. 2017: Change value analysis of natural area indicator in Polish municipalities beased on landuse. Proceedings of the 17th International Multidisciplinary Scientific GeoConference SGEM 2017. Albena. DOI: https://doi.org/10.5593/sgem2017/23 Ciolkosz, A., Bielecka, E. 2005: Pokrycie terenu w Polsce. Bazy danych CORINE Land Cover. Warszawa. Coppens, T. 2011: Conflict and conflict management in strategic urban projects. Heverlee. Corine Land Cover 2017. URL: https://clc.gios.gov.pl (1.5.2017). De Groot, R. 2006: Function-analysis and valuation as a tool to assess land use conflicts in planning for sustainable, multi-functional landscapes. Landscape and urban planning 75, 3-4. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/j.landurbplan.2005.02.016 Domingo Pastó, I. 2009: Spatial planning as 'co-evolution: linking expectations, uncertainties, and conflicts. A case study of supra-local plans in the Catalan Pyrenees (Spain). Wageningen. Braun, S., Wimmer, A. 2013: Civil Society Conflicts Environment & Social Conflicts. SSRN Electronic Journal. DOI: https://doi.org/10.2139/ssrn.2655023 Glasson, J., Marshall, T. 2007: Regional planning. New York. Hite, J. 1998: Land use conflicts on the urban fringe: Causes and potential resolution. Clemson. Hopkins, L. D. 2001: Urban development: the logic of making plans. Washington. Hrvatin, M., Perko, D. 2008: Landscape characteristics of common land in Slovenia. Acta geographica Slovenica 7-32. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS48101 Joshi, C. M., de Leeuw, J., van Duren, I. C. 2004: Remote sensing and GIS applications for mapping and spatial modelling of invasive species. Geo-imagery bridging continents, Proceedings of 20th ISPRS congress. Istanbul. Kennedy, A. 2017: Environmental justice and land use conflict: The governance of mineral and gas resource development. London, New York. Kieslich, P. J., Hilbig, B. E. 2014: Cognitive conflict in social dilemmas: An analysis of response dynamics. Judgment and Decision Making 9-6. Leedy, P. D., Ormrod, J. E. 2005: Practical research. Pearson Education. Mack, R. W., Snyder, R. C. 1957: The Analysis of Social Conflict. Toward an Overview and Synthesis. Conflict Resolution 1-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/002200275700100208 Markuszewska, I. 2018. Conflicts between legal policy and rural area management in Poland. Acta geographica Slovenica 58-1. NatSchAVO 1995. Naturschutz-Ausgleichsverordnung vom 30. März 1995 (SächsGVBl. S. 148, 196), die durch die Verordnung vom 5. Dezember 2001. Nolon, S., Ferguson, O., Field, P. 2013: Land in conflict: Managing and resolving land use disputes. Cambridge, Massachusetts. Smrekar, A., Šmid Hribar, M., Erhartič, B. 2016: Stakeholder conflicts in the Tivoli, Rožnik Hill, and Šiška Hill Protected Landscape Area. Acta geographica Slovenica 56-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.895 SMUL 2009. Handlungsempfehlung zur bewertung und bilanzierung von eingriffen im freistaat sachsen, Im Auftrag des Sächsischen Ministeriums für Umwelt und Landwirtschaft. Dresden. 56 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Strumillo-Rembowska, D., Bednarczyk, M., Cieslak, I. 2014: Data generation of vector maps using a hybrid method of analysis and selection of geodata necessary to optimize the process of spatial planning. Proceedings of the 9th International Conference »Environmental engineering«. Vilnius. von der Dunk, A., Gret-Regamey, A., Dalang, T., Hersperger, A. M. 2011: Defining a typology of peri-urban land-use conflicts - A case study from Switzerland. Landscape and urban planning 101-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.landurbplan.2011.02.007 Wehrmann, B. 2008: Land conflicts: A practical guide to dealing with land disputes. Eschborn. Young, J., Watt, A., Nowicki, P., Alard, D., Clitherow, J., Henle, K., Johnson, R., Laczko, E., McCracken, D., Matouch, S., Niemela, J., Richards, C. 2005: Towards sustainable land use: identifying and managing the conflicts between human activities and biodiversity conservation in Europe. Biodiversity and Conservation 14-7. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s10531-004-0536-z 57 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 59-117 SUSTAINABLE MOUNTAIN TOURISM IN WORD AND DEED: A COMPARATIVE ANALYSIS IN THE MACRO REGIONS OF THE ALPS AND THE DINARIDES Ivan Paunovic, Verka Jovanovic Sustainable mountain tourism can contribute significantly to sustainable development in the Alps and Dinarides. Ivan Paunovic, Verka Jovanovic, Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro ... DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.4630 UDC: 913:338.48(234.3+234.422.1) COBISS: 1.01 Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro regions of the Alps and the Dinarides ABSTRACT: This article examines similarities and differences in the attitudes and social representations of destination managers towards implementing sustainable tourism between the mountain regions of the Alps and the Dinarides. Bearing in mind the transnational impacts (i.e., environmental, economic and social) of the tourism industry the research methodology adopted an international perspective by sending a questionnaire to tourism organizations in fourteen different countries in the Alps and the Dinarides. The research is interdisciplinary in nature, because it integrates knowledge from sustainability and management science with tourism geography and social psychology. The findings confirm that social representations of sustainable tourism differ significantly in the two mountain regions. KEY WORDS: Sustainability, tourism geography, governance, mountain tourism, social representations of tourism, Alps, Dinarides Trajnostni gorski turizem v besedi in dejanju: primerjalna analiza v makroregijah Alp in Dinarskega gorstva IZVLEČEK: V članku avtorja preučujeta podobnosti in razlike v odnosu destinacijskih menedžerjev do izvajanja trajnostnega turizma na gorskih območjih Alp in Dinaridov oziroma primerjata socialne reprezentacije trajnostnega turizma na teh dveh območjih. Ker ima turistična dejavnost transnacionalne (okoljske, ekonomske in socialne) vplive, sta avtorja opravila mednarodno raziskavo, v kateri sta vprašalnike poslala turističnim organizacijam v 14 različnih državah na območju Alp in Dinarskega gorstva. Raziskava je interdisciplinarna, saj združuje znanja s področij trajnostnega razvoja, managementa, turistične geografije in socialne psihologije. Njeni izsledki potrjujejo, da se socialne reprezentacije trajnostnega turizma med obema preučevanima gorskima območjema precej razlikujejo. KLJUČNE BESEDE: trajnostnost, turistična geografija, upravljanje, gorski turizem, socialne reprezentacije turizma, Alpe, Dinarsko Ivan Paunovic, Verka Jovanovic Singidunum University paun.bg@gmail.com, vjovanovic@singidunum.ac.rs The article was submitted for publication on July 19th 2016. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 19. julija 2016. 60 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction In the Alps, sustainable development became an important paradigm at the level of the macro region soon after the publication of the report »Our Common Future« by the Brundtland Commission, through the first Alpine conference in Berchtesgaden in 1989, and ever since a coordinated transnational research has been conducted in the Alps through the Alpine Convention. (Borsdorf et al. 2015; WCED 1987). In the Dinarides however, there are still no strong transnational and cross-disciplinary political initiatives or research on sustainable development. This situation points to the potential differences in the social representations of sustainable tourism in the Dinarides. This article therefore opens a discussion on the governance and sustainability of tourism from the perspective of the mountain destination managers in the two macro regions: the Alps and the Dinarides. The Alps are a natural benchmark for the Dinarides not only as their closest neighbor but also as one of the leading mountain chains regarding research on the environmental and social impacts of mountain tourism. The article investigates the phenomenon of sustainable tourism in the Alps and the Dinarides as an interdisciplinary field of research between tourism geography, social psychology, sustainability science and management science. The Brundtland Commission has defined sustainable development as: »... development that meets the needs of the present without compromising the ability of the future generations to meet their own needs« (WCED 1987), and other institutions (UNEP and UNWTO 2005) emphasize that at the center of sustainable development are interdisciplinary perspectives (involving the economy, society, and environment) and global perspectives as well as ethical conduct. This means that sustainable destination planning and development are directly connected to destination values and leadership. Elakovic (2011) correctly notes that a critical-realistic approach to destination development (with humanistic values at its core) marks the mature phase of tourist destination development. The author further clarifies that improving leadership and management values is a task for every ethical manager in order to improve the full scope of organisational activites and lessen their negative impacts on the environment. In this sense, there is very little research on the social representations of tourism (Moscardo 2011), and none has been conducted on sustainable mountain tourism. Social representations are a specific way of understanding and communicating existing knowledge, somewhere between the raw concepts and percepts, which give meaning to the world around us (Moscovici and Duveen 2000). In short, representation is an image or a meaning. Social representations in tourism are what communities and other stakeholders believe or interpret about tourism and its impacts (Moscardo 2011). The central actor, whose social representation of sustainable tourism has been studied in this article are the destination management organizations (DMO) in the Alps and the Dinarides. DMO's are a central actor in coordination of various tourism stakeholders and as such they usually have the most knowledge about different types of destination stakeholders. Moscardo's (2011) analysis of tourism planning models in emerging destinations demonstrated that the predominant paradigm is a business approach, whereas sustainability issues have been totally neglected in most cases. Government planning has been considered by many as partly outdated and partly unnecessary, but effective management systems for sustainable tourism very often need government planning (Bramwell and Lane 2011). The two main factors shaping the planning of mountain and ski tourism are demographic change-as the most important factor, and climate change-as the second most important factor (Gossling and Scott 2012). However, this order is predicted to shift by the end of the century, when climate change will become the most important factor, and demographic change the second most important factor. Organizational approaches to this changes can vary from total rejection of a sustainability agenda and non-responsiveness, through compliance, eco-efficiency or strategic sustainability, all the way to ideological commitment (Dunphy and Benveniste 2000). Destination values and strategic directions always directly reflect destination leadership which is set in an inter-organizational context through distributed and systemic leadership (Pechlaner, Kozak and Volgger 2014). Leadership is considered by many to be a missing link in destination management theory (Bieger and Beritelli 2013). This is because the concepts of governance and networking go hand in hand, but are only able to resolve the issues of processes and how things are done, whereas the question of goals and strategies should be addressed through a framework of leadership or generally a more humanistic approach (Volgger and Pechlaner 2015). Having all this in mind, Waligo, Clarke and Hawkings (2013) note that leadership is essential in creating a common understanding about the values of sustainable development and 61 Ivan Paunovic, Verka Jovanovic, Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro ... its implementation at the destination. However, according to Yasarata et al. (2010), a pressurized political context as well as politicians' attitudes and values in some countries can significantly alter the implementation of sustainable development policies, compared to the original plans. The destination actors that have the power to choose or change the nature of tourism development can have a key impact on spreading the benefits of tourism development to the development of the entire destination and local community (Moscardo 2005). The most important aspect of this power is whether and how much it is based on knowledge. However, the problem with many developing destinations is that destination residents have a small or limited role in tourism planning, whereas the development is directed by foreign tour operators, often power-distant government departments and destination management organisations (Moscardo 2011). Mountain destinations in most of the Dinarides are definitely developing destinations where these kinds of issues are present, which is why development priorities should be compared to those of more developed mountain destinations, such as those in the Alps. The main goal of this article is to determine whether there are any differences in the social representations of sustainable tourism that affect the realization of sustainable tourism in the Alps compared to the Dinarides. The goal is also to identify the triggers of destination management differences that result in various problems in implementating sustainable tourism development. In this sense, the following four research questions have been developed: 1. How great is the importance of various stakeholders to destination management? 2. How great is the implementation of sustainability principles in destination planning? 3. What are the leadership or management values practiced at the destination? 4. What are the priorities of destination development? Author of the map background: Google Image Landsat 2016; US Department of State Geographer 2016; GeoBasis-DE/BKG 2009 Copyright for the map background: © Google, 2016 © GeoBasic-DE/BKG Figure 1: Position of the researched mountain areas in Europe: The Alps and the Dinarides. 62 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 2 Methods The research method used in this study was a questionnaire, and the sampling method was judgment sampling used as a nonprobability method, which means that sample was selected based on judgment. The questionnaire was translated into six languages and it used a seven-point Lickert scale for all of the questions (a five-point was not used intentionally, in order to avoid mistakes because there are, for example, differences in school grading in different countries), on which 7 was the highest score. The questionnaire was sent out via e-mail and as an online questionnaire (respondent could choose which one to use) to selected DMOs in areas over 1000m in elevation. Altogether, 1,213 organizations where included and seventy of them replied. The relatively low response rate (5.77%) was expected, given that previous research (Finkelstein, Hambrick and Cannella 2009) had indicated that professionals in management positions are not inclined to participate in research on leadership values. The distribution of the data collected is as follows: fourty-six in the Alps (six France, one in Liechtenstein, nine in Italy, seven in Germany, two in Alpine Slovenia, nine in Austria, and twelve in Switzerland) and twenty-four in the Dinarides-24 (one in Albania, ten in Bosnia and Herzegovina, three in Montenegro, one in Croatia, zero in Kosovo, four in Macedonia, one in Dinaric Slovenia, and four in Serbia). The research included the following types of organizations: tourism organizations, departments/sections for tourism and/or economic development (in charge of tourism) in local municipal institutions, regional tourism organizations, tourism societies, destination marketing organizations and regional development organizations. In the analysis phase, MS Excel was used to calculate the descriptive statistics, as well as SPSS to calculate statistical significance using t-tests. In the graphs and tables, statistical significance at the 0.05 level is marked with two asterisks. In this sense, it is important that the two samples (the Alps and Dinarides) were relatively well-balanced, because there is no statistically significant difference between the two groups in age, level of education, or any key competency of the respondents. The only statistically significant difference was in the sex of the respondents; there were more women in the Alps sample. 3 Results The results on the social representations of sustainable tourism in the management practice cover the following aspects of the destination management process in the two mountain regions: the importance given to the different types of stakeholders by the DMO (Figure 2), planning for sustainability at the destination (Figure 3 and Table 1), leadership/management values at the destination (Figure 4), and priorities of the destination development (Table 2). In all of the following tables and graphs, two asterisks »**« indicates statistically significant difference at the 0.05 level. Figure 2 shows that there are significant differences in stakeholder prioritization by the destination management organizations between the Alps and the Dinarides. One very important difference is that stakeholders are more evenly ranked in the Dinarides, whereas the three most important stakeholders are clearly more important than the other stakeholders in the Alps. As shown in Figure 3, self-evaluations about the implementation of sustainability principles in destination planning show a small difference. However, the differences between evaluation in word only and concrete actions become somewhat clearer in Table 1, Figure 4 and Table 2. Table 1: Planning for sustainability. Feature Likert scores (rank) Alps Dinarides Multidisciplinary sustainable development planning documents Economic/tourism development documents 4.17 (3rd) 4.94 (1st) 3.77 4.05 (3rd) Sepa rate cost-benefit a na lyses 2.98 3.14 Other 1.72 5.18 (2nd) 1.72 63 Ivan Paunovic, Verka Jovanovic, Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro ... On-line booking portals Public institutions 7 *Event organizers(MICE) **New media (Social media, Blogs, etc.) Traditional media (TV, Radio, Newspaper) *Environmental protection organizations **Non-governmental organisations **Education and Training organisations Accommodation industry Gastronomy Tourist agencies "Entertainment Transport companies organisations The Alps The Dinaric Alps Figure 2: Importance given to different types of stakeholders by the DMO's. Figure 3: Implementation of sustainability principles in destination planning (self-reported by DMOs). 64 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 » The Alps » The Dinaric Alps Figure 4: Leadership or management values in the destination. There is a statistically significant difference between the two mountain regions regarding documents used for planning sustainability regarding environmental protection, as well as laws. In both cases, these were significantly more important in the Dinarides than in the Alps. As shown in Table 1, economic/tourism development documents are the single most important document in the Alps, followed by environmental protection documents and multidisciplinary sustainable development planning documents (ranked first, second and third). In the Dinarides however multidisciplinary sustainable development planning documents are ranked only as a fourth priority. This means that in the Dinarides, environmental protection goals should be put into a broader social context (social and economic). In that sense, there is space for using more multidisciplinary general planning documents of sustainable development in the Dinarides. Top managers' choices are shown to be affected by their experiences, values and personality (Hambrick 2007; Hambrick and Mason 1984). This applies to DMOs in the same way as it does to other organizations. As shown in Figure 4, leadership or management values such as hard work, chain of command, protection of the environment and protection of nature score more importantly in the Dinarides. In this sense, for DMOs in the Dinarides there is an opportunity to create organizations that are more egalitarian (emphasizing the social equality of all co-workers) and rely less on hierarchy (or the chain of command). Similarly as with documents for planning sustainability, there is a noticeable polarization of answers towards environmental protection in the Dinarides, which also means that there is poorer integration of this aspect with other aspects of sustainability. Conversely, in the Alps, environmental protection of the destination is an aspect of sustainable development that needs additional specialized attention. 65 Ivan Paunovic, Verka Jovanovic, Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro ... Table 2: Priorities of destination development. Feature Likert scores (rank) Alps Dinarides **Tourism research 4.63 5.87 Market research 4.87 5.61 **Use of social media (LinkedIn, Facebook, Twitter) 4.83 5.87 **FDI (foreign direct investment) 2.96 5.52 Image and marketing Tourism product development 5.3/ 6.11 (1st) ç 11 Hrz-n 5.96 6.17 C, ilrri **Development of infrastructure **Destination stakeholder network improvement 5./2 (3rd) 5.09 c a 6.65 (1st) 5.91 c, nn/-n **Environmental protection **Regional or cross-border cooperation 5.22 5.02 A 6.61 (2nd) 6 a no **Human resources development Development of core competencies 4.76 4.98 A 1 6.09 5.48 Ç /10 **SME (small and medium-sized enterprises) support **Service quality 4.2 5.87 (2nd) 5.49 6.57 (3rd) Innovative products 5.70 5.83 Sustainable development 5.43 6.17 Energy efficiency 4.98 5.61 Although there are some differences in terms of leadership or management values, in terms of destination development priorities, there are significant differences (ten out of seventeen are significantly different), as shown in Table 2. This is understandable given the two regions' different levels of economic development. Priorities rated significantly higher in the Dinarides are tourism research, social media use, foreign direct investment, destination stakeholder network improvement, regional and cross-border cooperation and development, human resource development, and SME support. This surely doesn't mean that in the Alps the destination do not have a need for improvements in this areas, but rather that they are already sufficiently developed and are not considered a priority in future development, because these areas are already functional. When analyzed separately, the priorities of destination development (marked in parentheses) in the Alps are tourism products, service quality, and infrastructure development; in the Dinarides, they are infrastructure development, environmental protection and service quality. Infrastructure development and service quality are priorities for both destinations, but they are rated as significantly more important in the Dinarides. This finding says a great deal about the special importance of these two aspects (improvement of infrastructure and service quality) for the development of mountain destinations in the Dinarides, while at the same time trying to preserve the environment. This is a real challenge of sustainable tourism development in the Dinarides, and also something that should be studied more in future research. There is a space for investments in accommodation capacities, as well as accompanying IT industry in the Dinarides. An equally important finding concerns DMOs themselves, which should become organizationally less hierarchical (rely less on chain of command-Figure 4), with more employee empowerment in relation to managers or leaders, especially if the same educational structure of employees in both regions is taken into account. Alpine DMOs are significantly less focused on nature protection as a development priority and as a leadership value, and organizations for nature protection have less influence on the DMOs. Bearing in mind the general importance of gastronomy as a stakeholder, and service quality development as a development priority, developing the quality of gastronomic services is recommended in the both mountain regions. 4 Discussion Understanding the relation of the DMO to other destination actors in the mountain destinations is very important because policy changes, related to environmental, social and economic impacts can only be implemented in this DMO-stakeholders nexus. The most important difference in this sense is that in the Alps, 66 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 there is a stronger division between what Franch, Martini and Buffa (2008) identified as primary and secondary stakeholders, as related to power and influence at the destination. The most important stakeholders in the Alps are public institutions, accommodation and gastronomy, whereas the most important stakeholders in the Dinarides are education and training organizations, new media (social media, blogs, etc.), and culinary providers. The relatively low importance of the social dimension in sustainable development in the Dinarides is in line with the findings of Kovacic and Brecko Grubar (2016) regarding knowledge of sustainable development among Slovenian students, who also lack awareness of the social dimension. More importantly, it also confirms the findings of Byrd, Cardenas and Greenwood (2008) in the case of North Carolina, where, the authors emphasize the need to inform destination stakeholders about social issues and how they relate to sustainable development. Consequently, there is still much space in the Dinarides for better stakeholder integration and consultation, and this must be reflected in multidisciplinary general planning documents as evidenced in the literature (Waligo, Clarke and Hawkins 2013; Brida, Osti and Barquet 2010; Shunnaq, Schwab and Reid 2008). The results confirm that in the Alps there is a good trans-disciplinary development policy, because of the long tradition in transnational sustainable development, with the challenge of further improving environmental protection. This confirms the findings by Marzelli and Lintzmeyer (2015) that in the macro-region of the Alps, improvements are needed in natural resources management, although significant results have already been achieved so far. The sustainable tourism literature recognizes that destination planning paradigms are out of date (Waligo, Clarke and Hawkins 2013; Popesku 2011; Goeldner and Ritchie 2009; Krippendorf, Zimmer and Glauber 1985), especially for mountain destinations (Trawoeger 2014; Paunovic and Radojevic 2014; Blasco, Guia and Prats 2014; Dawson and Scott 2013), because they do not fully take into account broader social and environmental impacts of tourism in order to lessen the impact of the tourism industry on the environment and communities. This is why the results of this study are so important for tourism geography. They demonstrate the lack of interdisciplinarity in planning sustainable tourism in the Dinarides as well as an unused potential of flexible, soft policy instruments (compared to laws) in achieving sustainable tourism. Leadership is considered an essential part of addressing the »crisis of governance« involving the natural environment (Case et al. 2015; Young et al. 2007), an issue of great importance in mountain destinations, which are ecologically very sensitive (Prideaux 2009). Leadership values constitute an important part of the modern destination management process, in which economic, environmental and social values are all equally important. An important notion is also that not all people that declare themselves in favour of environmental protection really consider this a value because value is something that is a permanent priority and affects actual actions as well as the choice of policy instruments in the broader framework of governance (Smrekar 2011; Hall 2010). Research of declared values in the Dinarides revealed that, regarding DMO organization, hierarchies (i.e., chain of command and hard work) are much more important than in the Alps. This confirms the low priority of the social dimension of sustainability in the Dinarides (such are stakeholder involvement, social inclusion, partner networks, etc.). On the other hand, in the Alps the attitude towards the environment and nature protection at the destination could be improved, as shown in the Figure 4. The tourism industry has a strong impact on resources at the destination, especially on the local community at the destination, and at the same time the future of the tourist destination also depends on protecting those very same resources (Prideaux 2009; Goeldner and Ritchie 2009). Therefore, research plays an important role in informing those involved in tourism about available development alternatives and priorities while maintaining a holistic and systemic approach in dealing with tourism development (Prideaux 2009; Burns and Novelli 2008). This is particularly true for ecologically sensitive mountain regions such as the Alps and the Dinarides, which is why the results presented results should serve as a basis for further discussion on sustainable tourism development priorities. Why do certain regions have certain priorities, why do these priorities differ, and how do they change over time? Although there are general differences in the social representations of sustainable tourism between the Alps and the Dinarides, individual destinations within both regions can also vary significantly depending on the specific arrangements: the type of organization responsible for coordinating destination development, institutional arrangements and the local resources available (i.e., human, geographic, infrastructure, know-how, tradition, etc.). In this sense, future research on social representations of sustainable tourism should take two directions: 1) research can be conducted on larger samples and in different regions or types of destinations, and 2) a qualitative research approach (i.e., case studies and interviews) should complement the qualitative approach in order to provide greater understanding and interpretation of the results obtained. 67 Ivan Paunovic, Verka Jovanovic, Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro ... 5 Conclusion In order to enhance future sustainable tourism development in the Alps and Dinarides, geography and tourism research should advocate the constant communication of information and upgrading of knowledge of the entire tourism public regarding available development alternatives and priorities, especially taking into account the observed differences. Special emphasis should be put on exchange of best practices and improvement of the quality of all sustainable tourism elements. An important link in this process is understanding the social representations of sustainable mountain tourism. This is because the very same concept, such as sustainable tourism, can have completely different interpretations and social roles in different societies or communities. This study has confirmed that there are differences in this sense, and it has presented a detailed analysis of social representations of sustainable mountain tourism in the Alps and the Dinarides, as a basis for further research on implementing sustainable tourism. There are significant differences in the social representations of sustainable tourism regarding stakeholder prioritization, destination planning, leadership or management values, and destination development priorities. 6 References Bieger, T., Beritelli, P. 2013: Management von Destinationen. München. Blasco, D., Guia, J., Prats, L. 2014: Emergence of governance in cross-border destinations. Annals of Tourism Research 49. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.annals.2014.09.002 Borsdorf, A., Bender, O., Braun, F., Haller, A. 2015: Web-based instruments for strengthening sustainable regional development in the Alps. Acta geographica Slovenica 55-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.897 Bramwell, B., Lane, B. 2011: Editorial Introduction: Critical research on governance of tourism and sustainability. Journal of Sustainable Tourism 19, 4-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/09669582.2011.580586 Brida, J. G., Osti, L., Barquet, A. 2010: Segmenting Resident Perceptions towards Tourism-a Cluster Analysis with a Multinomial Logit Model of a Mountain Community. International Journal of Tourism Research 12-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1002/jtr.778 Burns, P., Novelli, M. 2008: Introduction: The Majority World Development and Tourism. Tourism Development-Growth, Myths and Inequalities. Oxfordshire. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1079/ 9781845934255.0000 Byrd, E. T., Cardenas, D. A., Greenwood, J. B. 2008: Factors of Stakeholder Understanding of Tourism: The Case of Eastern North Carolina. Tourism and Hospitality Research 8-3. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1057/thr.2008.21 Case, P., Evans, L. S., Fabinyi, M., Cohen, P. J., Hicks, C. C., Prideaux, M., Mills, D. J. 2015: Rethinking environmental leadership: The social construction of leaders and leadership in discourses of ecological crisis, development, and conservation. Leadership 11-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/1742715015577887 Dawson, J., Scott, D. 2013: Managing for climate change in the alpine ski sector. Tourism Management 35. DOI: httpss:/doi. org/ 10.1016/j .tourman.2 012.07.009 Dunphy, D., Benveniste, J. 2000: An introduction to the sustainable incorporation. Poslovna etika i komuniciranje. Beograd. Finkelstein, S., Hambrick, D., Cannella, A. J. 2009: Strategic leadership: Theory and research on executives, top management teams and boards. New York. Franch, M., Martini, U., Buffa, F. 2008: Strategie di brand management nelle destinazioni alpine community. Mercati e competitivita 4. Goeldner, C. R., Ritchie, J. R. 2009: Tourism Principles, Practices, Philosophies. Hoboken. Gössling, S., Scott, D. 2012: Scenario planning for sustainable tourism: an introduction. Journal of sustainable tourism 20-6. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/09669582.2012.699064 Hall, M. C. 2010: Policy Learning and policy failure in sustainable tourism governance: from first and second order to third order change? Journal of Sustainable Tourism 19, 4-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/ 09669582.2011.555555 Hambrick, D. 2007: Upper Echelons Theory: An Update. Academy of Management Review 32-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.5465/AMR.2007.24345254 68 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Hambrick, D., Mason, P. 1984: Upper Echelons: The Organization as a Reflection of Its Top Managers. Academy of Management Review 9-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.5465/AMR.1984.4277628 Kovacic, G., Brecko Grubar, V. 2016: Knowledge of sustainable development among geography students in Slovenia. Acta geographica Slovenica 56-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.1633 Krippendorf, J., Zimmer, P., Glauber, H. 1985: Für einen anderen Tourismus. Frankfurt am Main. Marzelli, S., Lintzmeyer, F. 2015: Transnational needs of sustainable spatial development in the Alps: results from an analysis of policy documents. Acta geographica Slovenica 55-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/ AGS.1585 Moscardo, G. 2005: Peripheral tourism development: Challenges, Issues and Success Factors. Tourism Recreation Research 30-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/02508281.2005.11081231 Moscardo, G. 2011: Exploring social representations of tourism planning: issues for governance. Journal of Sustainable Tourism 19, 4-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/09669582.2011.558625 Moscovici, S., Duveen, G. 2000: Social Representations: Explorations in Social Psychology. Cambridge. Paunovic, I., Radojevic, M. 2014: Towards green economy: balancing market and seasonality of demand indicators in Serbian mountain tourism product development. Trends in Tourism and Hospitality Industry. Opatija. Pechlaner, H., Kozak, M., Volgger, M. 2014: Destination leadership: a new paradigm for tourist destinations? Tourism Review 69-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/TR-09-2013-0053 Popesku, J. 2011: Menadzment turisticke destinacije. Belgrade. Prideaux, B. 2009: Resort Destinations-Evolution, Management and Development. Oxford. Shunnaq, M., Schwab, W A., Reid, M. F. 2008: Community development using a sustainable tourism strategy: a case study of the Jordan River Valley touristway. International Journal of Tourism Research 1-14. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1002/jtr.620 Smrekar, A. 2011: From environmental awareness in word to environmental awareness in deed: The case of Ljubljana. Acta geographica Slovenica 51-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS51203 Trawoeger, L. 2014: Convinced, ambivalent or annoyed: Tyrolean ski tourism stakeholders and their perceptions of climate change. Tourism Management 40. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.tourman.2013.07.010 Volgger, M., Pechlaner, H. 2015: Governing networks in tourism: what have we achieved, what is still to be done and learned? Tourism Review 70-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/TR-04-2015-0013 Waligo, V. M., Clarke, J., Hawkins, R. 2013: Implementing sustainable tourism: A multi-stakeholder involvement management framework. Tourism Management 36. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.tourman.2012.10.008 WCED - World commision on environment and development: Our common future - Brutland report. Oxford, 1987. Yasarata, M., Altinay, L., Burns, P., Okumus, F. 2010: Politics and sustainable tourism development - Can they co-exist? Voices from North Cyprus. Tourism Management 31-3. https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.tourman.2009.03.016 Young, O. R., Osherenko, G., Ekstrom, J., Crowder, L. B., Ogden, J., Wilson, J. A., Peach, R. 2007: Solving the Crisis in Ocean Governance: Place-Based Management of Marine Ecosystems. Environment 49-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3200/ENVT.49.4.20-33 69 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 71-117 GENDER, AGE AND EDUCATION DIFFERENCES IN FOOD CONSUMPTION WITHIN A REGION: CASE STUDIES OF BELGRADE AND NOVI SAD (SERBIA) Nikola Darko Vuksanovic, Dragan Tešanovic, Bojana Kalenjuk, Milijanko Portic Food consumption contributes significantly to regional development. Nikola Darko Vuksanovic, Dragan Tesanovic, Bojana Kalenjuk, Milijanko Portic, Gender, age and education differences... DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.5160 UDC: 911.3:338.48-6:641(497.1) 314:641(497.1) COBISS: 1.01 Gender, age and education differences in food consumption within a region: Case studies of Belgrade and Novi Sad (Serbia) ABSTRACT: Nowadays, each tourist visits a region for certain reasons, a different type of tourism, but besides the main motives, food and beverages are an inevitable attraction. Some tourists' characteristics, such as gender, age and education of tourists, contribute significantly to food and beverages consumption. The authors recognized the importance of gender, age, and education in analyzing food and beverage consumption as an important component of tourist products. The study makes a significant conceptual contribution towards the spatial/economic development for those who are seeking to integrate local food and beverage into the tourist product. KEY WORDS: geography, gender, age, education, food consumption, economic development, Belgrade, Novi Sad Razlike v porabi hrane v izbrani regiji na podlagi spola, starosti in izobrazbe: Primer Beograda in Novega Sada POVZETEK: Danes ima vsak turist svoje posebne razloge za obisk določene regije. Lahko si želi drugačne vrste turizma, poleg glavnih razlogov pa ga pritegneta zlasti lokalna hrana in pijača. Nekatere lastnosti turistov, kot so spol, starost in izobrazba, pomembno vplivajo na porabo hrane in pijače. Avtorji so pri analizi porabe hrane in pijače kot pomembne prvine turističnih proizvodov ugotovili, da imajo spol, starost in izobrazba pomembno vlogo. Raziskava ponuja pomemben konceptualni prispevek k prostorskemu/gospodarskemu razvoju tistih ponudnikov, ki poskušajo v svoje turistične proizvode vključiti lokalno hrano in pijačo. KLJUČNE BESEDE: geografija, spol, starost, izobrazba, poraba hrane, gospodarski razvoj, Beograd, Novi Sad Nikola Darko Vuksanovic Higher education school for management and business communication vuksanovicnikola85@gmail.com Dragan Tešanovic, Bojana Kalenjuk, Milijanko Portic University of Novi Sad, Faculty of Science, Department of Geography, Tourism and Hotel Management tesanovic.dragan@gmail.com, bojanakalenjuk@yahoo.com, porticprof@yahoo.com The paper was submitted for publication on July 3rd, 2017. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 3. julija 2017. 72 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction Tourists with different cultural and religious backgrounds and socio-demographic characteristics, as well as with different personality traits related to food and past experience may have different motivations for the food consumption within a region. Accordingly, the destination management is now using local food and beverages through the food culture and as an aesthetic experience for tourists, which causes pleasant emotions, increases their understanding of local community and culture, satisfies their curiosity about local community and fulfils tourists' need to learn about the local culture (Chang, Kivela and Mak 2011). The purpose of our previous research (Vuksanovic et al. 2017) was to examine the differences between the demographic and socio-economic characteristics of foreign tourists, as determinants, in the perception of local gastronomy, while in this study authors analyzed gender, age, and education of foreign tourists in relation to food and beverage consumption as an important component of tourist product. The research was done in two cities, but authors recommend that for future research it would be very useful to replicate this research in other regions (mountain, spa and other forms of tourism) and cities (Subotica, Niš, Kragujevac) across the Republic of Serbia. The scale used in previous research (Vuksanovic et al. 2017) referred to local gastronomy and included three aspects (according to Jalis et al. 2009; Qing-Chi et al. 2013) of food distinctiveness and accessibility, food diversity and enjoyment, and food quality and presentation. The work of Vuksanovic et al. (2017) leaves a room for new research, for example, examining whether gender, age and education of foreign tourists have an impact on food and beverages consumption within a region. The results of previous studies (Mak et al. 2012; Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009) highlighted that socio-demographic characteristics of tourists (gender, age and education) are important factor in measuring food consumption. From the aspect of geography, food is the field of human geography. Geography deals with spatial processes in human and physical environments. Such processes have an impact on food, and they can be viewed through multiple geographical disciplines (physical, social, medical and economic geography) (Gillespie 2001). Geographers dealing with physical, economic, social, urban, rural, cultural, medical and agricultural geography have their own views on the analysis of the food system. They analyze the production, consumption, supply and distribution of food from the local to the global level (Atkins and Bowler 2001). Figure 1: Serbian cuisine. 73 Nikola Darko Vuksanovic, Dragan Tesanovic, Bojana Kalenjuk, Milijanko Portic, Gender, age and education differences... In previous studies (Buller 2014; McDonagh 2014; Tornaghi 2014; Woods 2012), many authors have dealt with research on food geographies, and other disciplinary discussions around food. Previous research (Brice 2014; Dudley 2011; Poe et al. 2014; Yeh and Lama 2013), pointed out that interconnection between space and identity is interrogated through the production and consumption of food, food places and through the broader political-economies of food ecologies and practices. Mak et al. (2012) identified five main socio-cultural and psychological factors oftourist food consumption (motivational factors, religious and cultural influences, food-related personality traits, exposure and past experience, and socio-demographic factors). They claimed that these five factors are interconnected and that socio-demographic effects are just as important as other factors that affect the tourist's tendency toward food consumption. A large number of studies show that food can be a major or one of the main motivators for traveling to a destination (Hall and Mitchell 2005; Long 2004; Mak et al. 2012; Hjalager and Richards 2002). In addition, Kivela and Crotts (2006) emphasized that food as a main motivation for travel is a valid construct and that food plays an important role that affects the overall tourism experience. Currently, the religion is considered to be a very important determinant affecting food selection and consumption (Sheldon and Fox 1988) while the culture is a major determinant that affects type of food that a person considers acceptable for consumption (Prescott et al. 2002). Kim, Eves and Scarles (2009) pointed out that food-related personality traits and past experience (the exposure effect) can be determinants which influence food consumption. At the same time, socio-demographic characteristics of an individual can be a determinant that affects food consumption. In the field of tourism and hospitality research, several studies (Ignatov and Smith 2006; Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009; Khan 1981; Mitchell and Hall 2003) indicated that tourists' demographic and socio-economic characteristics influence their preferences towards local food. Some studies (Furst et al. 1996; Khan 1981; Randall and Sanjur 1981) related to food consumption recognized socio-demographic characteristics as significant variables in explaining variations in food consumption. Franklin and Crang (2001) indicated that demographic variables significantly influence choices for a region. In other way, studies that used sociode-mographic variables assume that these variables are oversized (Schofield and Thompson 2007; Huh, Uysal and McCleary 2006) - i.e. they pointed out that gender and age are the least significant differentiating variables for the motivation dimensions. Previous studies showed that female respondents, as compared to male, are more interested in and more excited about degustation of local food when they are on vacation (Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009; Ignatov and Smith 2006) and that they are more price sensitive and ready to taste new or unusual fruit and vegetables (Mitchell and Hall 2003). Thus, the following hypothesis is proposed: H1 - There are statistically significant differences between male and female foreign tourists in relation to food and beverage consumption within a region. In the field of tourism and hospitality research, the consumption of food is narrowed for elder respondents (Tse and Crotts 2005) and that they are more health concerned (Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009), while Olsen (2003) quotes that older tourists can be positively oriented towards consumption of sea food. Based on the above-mentioned findings, the following hypothesis is proposed: H2 - There are statistically significant differences among foreign tourists of different age groups in relation to food and beverage consumption within a region. A common agreement among researchers is that the respondents with higher education level are more health concerned (Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009), that higher education level increases food related sensation (Glanz et al. 1998) and that the respondents with higher education level have more tendencies towards local food consumption (Zeppel and Hall 1991). Wadolowska, Babicz-Zielinska and Czarnocinska (2008) pointed out that the respondents with primary education have a negative or neutral perception of food. Considering the results of earlier research, this study has the following hypothesis: H3 - There are statistically significant differences among foreign tourists of different level of education in relation to food and beverage consumption within a region. This study will focus on foreign tourists who visited Belgrade and Novi Sad (the Republic of Serbia). At the same time, the purpose of this paper was to examine the differences between the gender, age and education of foreign tourists and the cities in relation to food and beverages consumption within a region as an important component of tourist product. 74 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 2 Methods Fieldwork for this study was carried out in Belgrade and Novi Sad in the Republic of Serbia. Both cities are the administrative, economic, political and cultural centres (Garaca, Jovanovic and Zakic 2011). Belgrade is located at the confluence of the Sava and Danube rivers, where the Pannonian Plain meets the Balkan Peninsula, while Novi Sad is located in the south of the Pannonian Plain. With their history, cultural assets and high quality accommodation facilities, Belgrade and Novi Sad host many domestic and international events (Internet 1 ; Internet 2). Thus, they are mostly considered cultural regions (Garaca, Jovanovic and Zakic 2011). Along with a cultural heritage deeply rooted in history, the cities offer opportunities for their visitors to taste the unique delicacies of local cuisine in the traditional restaurants scattered across the cities. Large number of restaurants allowed researchers to reach a great number of tourists and that was one of the main reasons for their selection. The survey was conducted on-site at casual local eateries (e.g. restoran domace kuhinje) and fine dining restaurants located in the streets Skadarlija (Belgrade) and Zmaj Jovina (Novi Sad). These two streets have nearly 50 restaurants with local cuisine and therefore they are mostly visited by foreign tourists (Internet 3; Internet 4).According to the data obtained from the Statistical Office of the Republic of Serbia (Internet 5), Belgrade and Novi Sad were visited mostly during these two months and in the last ten years. A team of ten researchers - previously trained graduated gastronomy and marketing students - undertook the survey during different days of the week (usually during afternoon and in the evening), over a period of two months (June-July, 2016). During the survey period, 1000 questionnaires were distributed, and 674 usable questionnaires were returned (usable response rate = 67.4%).In Table 1 presents design ofthe sample which includes information about sample and population, sampling error and confidence level. Table 1: The sample design research data. Collection method Self-administrated questionnaire Sampling unit Tourist over 18 years of age; tasted food and beverage during his/her stay in Belgrade and Novi Sad (the Republic of Serbia) Population size 455.957 per year Sample Type Simple random sample Belgrade Novi Sad Confidence level 95% 99% Sampling error 3.8% 5% The questionnaire was composed of three parts. The first part of the questionnaire was an agreement of respondents to fill in the questionnaire. The questionnaire was anonymous. The second part referred to demographic and socio-economic characteristics of respondents: gender, age, education, occupation, reason for visiting the region and country of tourist's origin. The last part contained a list of eight food and beverage attributes compiled based on previous studies (Qing-Chi et al. 2013; Verbeke and Lopez 2005). Earlier studies (Baloglu and McCleary 1999) have indicated that the term »local food« contributes to the popularity of region and tourist consumption of food. The answers were measured by using the Likert scale, as follows: 1 - Strongly disagree, 2 - Disagree, 3 - Neutral, 4 - Agree, 5 - Strongly agree. 3 Results 3.1 Characteristics of the respondents The demographic profile of the respondents is summarized in Table 2. The study included 674 respondents of which 332 were in Novi Sad and 342 in Belgrade. Out of the total number of respondents, 51.3% were male and 48.7% female. Almost half of the respondents are younger people, 18 to 30 years of age. 75 Nikola Darko Vuksanovic, Dragan Tesanovic, Bojana Kalenjuk, Milijanko Portic, Gender, age and education differences... Table 2: Respondents'demographic data (n = 674). Variables Sample size Share Variables Sample size Share Gender Occupation Male 346 51.3% Unemployed 43 6% Female 328 48.7% Retired 24 4% Employed 489 72.5% Student 118 17.5% Age Reason for visit 18-30 316 47% Vacation 175 26% 31-40 167 25% Business purposes 140 21% 41-50 95 14.5% Shopping 98 14.9% 51-60 72 10.5% Visiting friends 100 15.1% over 60 24 3% Food and culture 37 5% Other 124 18% Education Region Primary Education 117 16.9% Ex-Yugoslavian countries 306 46% Secondary Education 232 34% West Europe 272 40% Higher education 120 18.1% South Europe 47 6.9% Master's degree 111 15.5% East Europe 49 7.1% Doctor's degree 94 12.5% In Table 3 is shown descriptive analysis of the scale items for food and beverages consumption. The scale is operationalized as the sum of responses to all items from the third part of the questionnaire. A higher score indicates better attitude towards of food and beverages consumption. Based on the values presented in Table 4, it can be concluded that the answers of respondents at the food and beverages consumption scale do not deviate significantly as compared to a normal distribution. In this research, reliability coefficients expressed in Cronbach alpha are 0.82. Table 3: Descriptive statistics of items used for research of food and beverages consumption. Scale Novi Sad Belgrade Mean Standard Deviation Mean Standard Deviation 1. Most of local food and beverages stimulated my appetite. 4.49 0.752 4.41 0.878 2. I didn't mind eating local food and drinking beverages at any time. 4.34 1.02 4.16 1.05 3. I enjoyed most local food and beverages during my vacation. 4.56 0.70 4.55 0.78 4. I spent a lot on local food and beverages during my vacation. 4.06 1.04 4.03 1.11 5. I had local food and beverages just for the sake of tasting it. 3.74 1.27 3.61 1.29 6. I consumed just those local food and beverages that I was familiar with. 3.19 1.30 3.23 1.43 7. The taste and look of most local food and beverages are of the same taste wherever I consumed them. 3.44 1.15 3.39 1.18 8. I only consumed local food and beverages for a few days during my vacation. 3.41 1.31 3.20 1.41 Table 4: Descriptive scale indicators. Scale Min Max M SD Skew. Kurt. K-S a Food and beverages consumption 19.00 50.00 39.99 5.09 0.625 1.066 0.292* 0.82 Note: *p < 0.1: Min. - minimal score; Max. - maximal score; M - arithmetic mean; SD - standard deviation; Skew. - Skewness; Kurt. - Kurtosis; K-S - Kolmogorov-Smirnov statistics; a - scale reliability measured by internal consistency 76 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 3.2 Differences between the cities The results of T-test for independent samples indicate a significant difference between tourists who visited Novi Sad (M = 40.33, SD = 4.88) and those who visited Belgrade (M = 39.64, SD = 5.28). The value of T-test is 1.83, and it is statistically significant (p < 0.05). The results show that foreign tourists who visited Novi Sad consumed a slightly more food and beverages in relation to tourists who visited Belgrade. 3.3 Differences between gender, age and education in food and beverages consumption The results indicate that there are differences between the variables gender, age and education (Table 5). Differences between groups were analysed by ANOVA, with the independent variables: gender, age and education, and the dependent variables are food and beverages consumption. Table 5: ANOVA analysis for gender, age and education in food and beverages consumption. Variables Interaction/city Main effects of socio-demographic Main effect of city Gender F(3, 669) = = 3.04, p < 0.03, q2p = 0.03 F (1,669) = 3.04, p < 0.01,n2p = 0.02 F (1,669) = 4.82, p < 0.03, q2p = 0.01 Age F(4,662): = 4.61, p <0.05, n2p = 0.01 F (1,662) = 1.93, p < 0.02,n2p= 0.02 F(4, 662) = 5.58, p <0.00, q2p = 0.02 Education F(4, 662) = = 3.04, p < 0.02, n2( = 0.02 F(4, 662) = 1,97, p < 0.09 F(1, 662) = 18.26, p=0.00, q2 p = a02 Note: *p < 0.5: post hock tests (TukeyS HSD). 4 Discussion The findings show that there are differences between men and women when it comes to food and beverages consumption. Male tourists from Novi Sad show a tendency towards a more positive attitude towards of food and beverages consumption, compared to other groups of respondents from Belgrade. However, the differences can be explained by physiological characteristics between man and women where man are more likely attracted with large portions and selection of meat dishes in relation to women. Also, one of the explanations can be that food choices are based on an individual level and their association with the aspects socio-economic factors (Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009; Khan 1981; Ignatov and Smith 2006; Mitchell and Hall 2003). Therefore, the hypothesis 1 has been confirmed. At one side, these differences between genders, mentioned above, are good indicators that can be used as a benchmark with previous results and be of use to marketing professionals to further enhance the offer on the region. On the other side, restaurant managers need to reduce the gender gap by applying different strategies, that will be focused on promotion - for example: special menu (both for men and women), the size of portions and different type of meals (vegetarian, vegan). The results indicate that there is difference between respondents depending to which age group they belong. There is a significant difference between respondents from the category of 18-30 years of age and the respondents who fall into the category 51-60 years of age. Further on, the same test shows that there is a difference between respondents who are 31-40 years of age and the respondents who are 41-50 years of age, as well as in relation to respondents who fall in the category between 51-60 years of age. More precisely, respondents who belong to elderly category (51-60 years of age), more positive attitude towards food and beverages, which is in accordance with previous research (Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009; Tse and Crotts 2005; Olsen 2003). Therefore, the hypothesis 2 has been confirmed. Professionals from marketing and hospitality industry need to be familiar with differences between age groups in order to be able to form different offers for different age groups. For example, for the age group from 51 to 60, a meal offered to them can be formed so to satisfy their dietary needs (for example, low salt, low calories, allergen info) while for the age group from 18 to 30, an affordable price can be used in promotion. The results indicate that there are differences between people with different education level when it comes to food and beverages consumption. The results show that respondents who visited Novi Sad and 77 Nikola Darko Vuksanovic, Dragan Tesanovic, Bojana Kalenjuk, Milijanko Portic, Gender, age and education differences... have master's degree differ from respondents who visited the same city but have higher education or primary education. Also, it is indicated that the same respondents differ from all other categories that visited Belgrade - from those who have completed secondary education, who have higher education, primary education, as well as from those respondents who have completed PhD. Possible differences between the groups of respondents for the variable education (respondents with university education gave more positive attitude towards of food and beverages consumption), can be explained with the fact that they were probably more informed about local food before they travelled to a region. To be more precise, the respondents who visited Novi Sad and have completed master's degree spend much more money on the food and beverage as compared to other respondents, irrespective of the city. Earlier studies (Zeppel and Hall 1991; Glanz et al. 1998) have confirmed that the respondents with higher level of education (university' degree) have more tendencies towards consumption of local food, which is in accordance with the obtained results in this research. These differences can be explained by the fact that highly educated respondents do not see local cuisine just as a way of appeasing hunger, but also as a medium to experience the region (Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009; Wadolowska, Babicz-Zielinska and Czarnocinska 2008). Therefore, the hypothesis 3 has been confirmed. Based on the results, restaurant managers need to pay more attention when comes to reservations from special group (like proffesors from University), as it turned out that consumption differs in relation to education. For example, respondents with a higher level of education are more willing to try food and beverages, and it is necessary to provide a different supply of food and beverages for them. The offer can contain an equal choice of domestic and international dishes and different sizes of portions. In addition, the promotion of food and beverages can be directed to a specific educated group. For example, tourists with a higher level of education may be offered with certain type of meals (e.g. with specific dietary needs) because previous researches (Kim, Eves and Scarles 2009; Tse and Crotts 2005) have shown that they are more concerned about health. From a practical point of view, this study provides valuable information for tourism and hospitality managers. Although tourists have expressed positive attitude on food and beverage, it is necessary to improve the efficiency of regulatory institutions, including the Food Safety Agency and the Nacional tourist organization of the Republic of Serbia. In accordance to that, the responsible goverment bodies should monitor the work of tourist companies at all levels. Monitoring is necessary in order to avoid and prevent inappropriate enterprise behaviour, to publish information related to local cuisine and to solve tourists' complaints. Also, monitoring reduces tourist dissatisfaction and improves positive evaluation of local cuisine perception. At the same time, this can increase the overall satisfaction of tourists with chosen destinations. 5 Conclusion The study advances literature on the use of tourists' socio-demographic characteristics in region, by examining the attitude towards food and beverage consumption in the spatial geographical context. The results indicate that gender, age and education within a region are an important antecedent of tourist consumption and an important component of the tourist products. This study provides valuable insight to practitioners who are seeking to integrate local food and beverage into the tourist product and how to improve acceptability to foreign tourists. In addition, this research makes it possible for the sectors of economy and government to understand better the significance of food and beverages consumption as part of the region, and towards the spatial/economic development. ACKNOWLEDGMENT: The study resulted as a part of project of Provincial Secretariat for Higher Education and Scientific Research, no. 142-451-2669 / 2017-01 / 02 (Agricultural, food and gastronomic products in the function of development of Vojvodina tourism directed towards authentic and safe food). 6 References Atkins, P., Bowler, I. 2001: Food in society. New York: Oxford University Press. Baloglu, S., McCleary, K. W 1999: US international pleasure travellers' images of four Mediterranean destinations: A comparison of visitors and nonvisitors. Journal of travel research 38-2. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1177/004728759903800207 78 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Brice, J. 2014: Attending to grape vines: Perceptual practices, planty agencies and multiple temporalities in Australian viticulture. Social and Cultural Geography 15-8. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/ 14649365.2014.883637 Buller, H. 2014: Animal geographies 1. Progress in Human Geography 38-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/ 0309132513479295 Chang, R. C., Kivela, J., Mak, A. H. 2011: Attributes that influence the evaluation of travel dining experience: When East meets West. Tourism Management 3-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.tourman.2010.02.009 Dudley, S. 2011: Feeling at home: Producing and consuming things in Karenni refugee camps on the ThaiBurma border. Population, Space and Place 17-6. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1002/psp.639 Franklin, A., Crang, M. 2001: The trouble with tourism and travel theory. Tourist Studies 1-1. Furst, T., Connors, M., Bisogni, C. A., Sobal, J., Falk, L. W. 1996: Food choice: a conceptual model of the process. Appetite 26-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1006/appe.1996.0019 Garaca, V., Jovanovic, G., Zakic, L. 2011: Interdestinacijska funkcionalna zavisnost - slucaj Beograda i Novog Sada. Teme 35-1. Gillespie, C. 2001: European gastronomy into the 21st century. Oxford: Linacre House-Jordan Hill. Glanz, K., Basil, M., Maibach, E., Goldberg, J., Snyder, D. A. N. 1998: Why Americans eat what they do: taste, nutrition, cost, convenience, and weight control concerns as influences on food consumption. Journal of the American Dietetic Association 98-10. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/S0002-8223(98)00260-0 Hall, C. M., Mitchell, R. 2005: Gastronomic tourism: Comparing food and wine tourism experiences. Niche tourism: Contemporary issues, trends and cases. Oxford. Hjalager, A. M., Richards, G. 2002: Tourism and Gastronomy. London. Huh, J., Uysal, M., McCleary, K. 2006: Cultural/Heritage Destinations: Tourist Satisfaction and Market Segmentation. Journal of Hospitality & Leisure Marketing 14-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1300/J150v14n03_07 Ignatov, E., Smith, S. 2006: Segmenting Canadian culinary tourists. Current Issues in Tourism 9-3. Internet 1: https://www.tob.rs/what-to-see/attractions (20. 8.2017). Internet 2: https://novisad.travel/en/kategorija-lokacije/turisticke-atrakcije-en/# (20. 8.2017). Internet 3: https://www.tob.rs/what-to-see/attractions/skadarlija (20.8.2017). Internet 4: https://novisad.travel/en/kategorija-lokacije/restorani-en/ (20. 8.2017). Internet 5: https://webrzs.stat.gov.rs/ (25.9.2016). Jalis, M. H., Zahari, M. S., Zulkifly, M. I., Othman, Z. 2009: Malaysian gastronomic tourism products: Assessing the level of their acceptance among the western tourists. South Asian Journal of Tourism and Heritage 2-1. Khan, M. 1981: Evaluation of food selection patterns and preferences. CRC Critical Reviews in Food Science and Nutrition 15. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/10408398109527314 Kim, Y. G., Eves, A., Scarles, C. 2009: Building a model of local food consumption on trips and holidays: A grounded theory approach. International Journal of Hospitality Management 28-3. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/j.ijhm.2008.11.005 Kivela, J. J., Crotts, J. C. 2006: Gastronomy tourism: A meaningful travel market segment. Journal of Culinary Science & Technology 4, 2-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1300/J385v04n02_03 Long, L. M. 2004: Culinary Tourism. Kentucky. Mak, A. H., Lumbers, M., Eves, A., Chang, R. C. 2012: Factors influencing tourist food consumption. International Journal of Hospitality Management 31-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ijhm.2011.10.012 McDonagh, J. 2014: Rural geography II: Discourses of food and sustainable rural futures. Progress in Human Geography 38-6. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/0309132513514507 Mitchell, R., Hall, C. M. 2003: Consuming tourists: Food tourism consumer behaviour. Food tourism around the world: Development, management and markets. Abingdon. Olsen, S. O. 2003: Understanding the relationship between age and seafood consumption: the mediating role of attitude, health involvement and convenience. Food Quality and Preference 14. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/S0950-3293(02)00055-1 Poe, M. R., LeCompte, J., McLain, R., Hurley, P. 2014: Urban foraging and the relational ecologies of belonging. Social and Cultural Geography 15-8. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/14649365.2014.908232 Prescott, J., Young, O., O'Neill, L., Yau, N. J. N., Stevens, R. 2002: Motives for food choice: a comparison of consumers from Japan, Taiwan, Malaysia and New Zealand. Food quality and preference 13, 7-8. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/S0950-3293(02)00010-1 79 Nikola Darko Vuksanovic, Dragan Tesanovic, Bojana Kalenjuk, Milijanko Portic, Gender, age and education differences... Qing-Chi, C. G., Chua, B. L., Othman, M., Ab Karim, S. 2013: Investigating the structural relationships between food image, food satisfaction, culinary quality, and behavioral intentions: The case of Malaysia. International Journal of Hospitality & Tourism Administration 14-2. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1080/15256480.2013.782215 Randall, E., Sanjur, D. 1981: Food preferences - their conceptualization and relationship to consumption. Ecology of food and nutrition 11-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/03670244.1981.9990671 Schofield, P., Thompson, K. 2007: Visitor motivation, satisfaction and behavioural intention: the 2005 Naadam Festival, Ulaanbaatar. International journal of tourism research 9-5. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1002/jtr.638 Sheldon, P. J., Fox, M. 1988: The Role Of Foodservice In Vacation Choice And Experience: A Cross-Cultural Analysis. Journal of Travel Research 27-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/004728758802700202 Tornaghi, C. 2014: Critical geography of urban agriculture. Progress in Human Geography 38-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/0309132513512542 Tse, P., Crotts, J. C. 2005: Antecedents of novelty seeking: international visitors' propensity to experiment across Hong Kong's culinary traditions. Tourism Management 26-6. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.tourman.2004.07.002 Verbeke, W, Lopez, G. P. 2005: Ethnic food attitudes and behaviour among Belgians and Hispanics living in Belgium. British Food Journal 107-11. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1108/00070700510629779 Vuksanovic, N., Tešanovic, D., Kalenjuk, B., Portic, M., Kneževic, M. 2017: Socio - demographic characteristics as determinants of differences in perception of local gastronomy. Economics of Agriculture 64-1. Wadolowska, L., Babicz-Zielinska, E., Czarnocinska, J. 2008: Food choice models and their relation with food preferences and eating frequency in the Polish population. Food Policy 33. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/j.foodpol.2007.08.001 Woods, M. 2012: Rural geography III: Rural futures and the future of rural geography. Progress in Human Geography 36-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/0309132510393135 Yeh, E. T., Lama, K. T. 2013: Following the caterpillar fungus: Nature, commodity chains, and the place of Tibet in China's uneven geographies. Social and Cultural Geography 14-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/ 14649365.2013.765025 Zeppel, H., Hall, C. M. 1991: Selling art and history: cultural heritage and tourism. Journal of Tourism Studies 2-1. 80 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA GEOGRAFSKI ZBORNIK 2019 SPECIAL ISSUE Franciscean cadaster as a source of studying landscape changes EDITORS: Matej Gabrovec Ivan Bičik Blaž Komac 81 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 83-117 LAND REGISTERS AS A SOURCE OF STUDYING LONG-TERM LAND-USE CHANGES Matej Gabrovec, Ivan Bičik, Blaž Komac Matej Gabrovec, Ivan Bicik, Blaz Komac, Land registers as a source of studying long-term land-use changes DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.7349 UDC: 911.2:711.14(4) 911.53(4) COBISS: 1.02 Land registers as a source of studying long-term land-use changes ABSTRACT: Land registers, or cadasters, contain information on land use because this is vital for land assessment and taxation. Some European countries produced land registers covering their entire territories as early as the nineteenth century. In the first half of the nineteenth century, the Habsburg Monarchy produced the Franciscean Cadaster, also known as the Stable Cadaster, which shows the traditional preindustrial cultural landscape and makes it possible to analyze land-use changes or the transformation of the traditional cultural landscape. This special issue is the result of collaboration between Slovenian and Czech geographers, and it features six articles covering land-use changes from the perspective of natural geography, political geography, ecosystems, farms, and metrics. The articles, which explore the processes of changes at the national and regional levels, are based on the textual part of the Franciscan Cadaster, and the local studies are based on the cartographic part of the cadaster. KEY WORDS: geography, agrarian geography, historical geography, land-use changes, Franciscean cadaster, Europe Zemljiški kataster kot vir proučevanja dolgoročnih sprememb rabe zemljišč POVZETEK: Zemljiški kataster vsebuje podatek o rabi zemljišč, ker je ta podatek pomemben za njihovo vrednotenje in obdavčitev. Nekatere evropske države so že v 19. stoletju izdelale kataster za območje celotne države. Habsburška monarhija je v prvi polovici 19. stoletja izdelala tako imenovani franciscejski ali stabilen kataster. Kataster prikazuje tradicionalno, predindustrijsko kulturno pokrajino in omogoča analize spremembe rabe zemljišč oziroma preobrazbo tradicionalne kulturne pokrajine. Posebna številka je rezultat sodelovanja med slovenskimi in češkimi geografi, obsega šest prispevkov, ki obravnavajo spremembe rabe zemljišč z naravno- ter političnogeografskega, ekosistemskega, kmetijskogospodarskega in metričnega vidika. Članki, ki obravnavajo procese sprememb na državni ali regionalni ravni, temeljijo na pisnem delu, krajevne študije pa na kartografskem delu franciscejskega katastra. KLJUČNE BESEDE: geografija, agrarna geografija, historična geografija, spremembe rabe zemljišč, franciscejski kataster, Evropa Matej Gabrovec, Blaž Komac Research Center of the Slovenian Academy of Sciences and Arts, Anton Melik Geographical Institute matej @zrc-sazu. si, blaz@zrc- sazu. si Ivan Bmk Charles University in Prague, Faculty of Science, Department of Social Geography and Regional Development bicik@natur.cuni.cz The paper was submitted for publication on March 14th, 2019. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 14. marca 2019. 84 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction This special issue of Acta geographica Slovenica features articles dealing with land-use changes. The series of articles presented continues the long-standing tradition of exploring land-use changes in Slovenian geography (Ilesic 1950; Medved 1970; Gabrovec and Kladnik 1997; Gabrovec and Kumer 2019), and the collaboration with fellow researchers from the Czech Republic (Bicík, Jelecek and Stepánek 2001; Bicík et al. 2015) extends this research into other parts of central Europe. The six articles featured in this special issue are presented in greater detail in Section 3 of this article but here it is sufficient to say that land-use changes are discussed from the perspective of natural geography, political geography, ecosystems, farms, and metrics. Land use is an important human footprint (Komac 2009) in a landscape, and landscape changes reveal a great deal about the geographical processes shaping it (Smid Hribar et al. 2017; Spulerová et al. 2017; Gersic Gabrovec and Zwitter 2018). Just as territoriality is the primary expression of social power, land-use changes are an important aspect of the historical relationships between society and space. Land-use changes in Europe reflect a combination of traces of feudal, industrial, and postindustrial processes, including settlement, whereas elsewhere the influences of precolonial land use on later processes can be observed. For example, the earliest European settlers in the Americas had a clear preference for sites with a long history of Native American occupation located on productive wide floodplains (Coughlan and Nelson 2018). Surprisingly, even in today's technology- and information-based society, agriculture remains the most important factor in land-use change on Earth, considering that approximately a third of its surface is used for growing crops or grazing. Agricultural land transformation has been especially rapid in the past three hundred years (Ramankutty et al. 2006). Various types of sources are available for determining land use and its changes. Remote sensing has been at the forefront in recent decades, and various textual and cartographic historical sources are available for older periods. Land registers, or cadasters, are key among these and their introduction is connected with the economic transformation mentioned above. Land registers usually entail parcel-based information systems featuring information on land use and the related rights and restrictions (Foski et al. 2018). They include a textual part and a graphic section or cadastral maps, which show the relative and absolute locations of parcels in a specific area (usually a cadastral district). Maps are produced at a scale of one to several hundred up to one to several tens of thousands. Historically, there were two reasons for maintaining records on land use: fiscal and legal. Income and the related taxation depend on land use, which is hence the key piece of information of any land register. The land register itself is a useful tool for recognizing and controlling land rights, such as ownership (Lisec and Navratil 2014). The applicability of land-register data to analyses conducted at the regional level depends on the method of publishing these data and varies by country and historical period. If land use is marked on cadastral maps in different colors, scanning and georeferencing these maps makes it possible to include land-use data in geographical information systems and analyze land-use changes (Petek and Urbanc 2004; Yang et al. 2014). The publication of summary tables on land use at the municipal level by year allows comparative studies of long-term land-use changes (Bicík, Jelecek and Stepánek 2001; Petek and Urbanc 2004; Bicík et al. 2015; Gabrovec and Kumer 2019). 2 Brief historical overview Landed properties were represented on a map to a limited extent in ancient Mesopotamia. The Royal Registry of ancient Egypt was created in about 3000 BC (Kain and Baigent 1992), and in China the taxation system based on land survey records was established in AD 700. The Romans carried out a land survey in AD 300, and they held regular and detailed censuses, such as Emperor Vespasian's AD 77 survey map in Campania (Larsson 1996; Kain and Baigent 1992). Since the Classical period, accurate cadastral records have been an important tool for proving ownership of land, which in turn earned people substantial privileges such as citizenship (Manville 1990); this predominated until the twentieth century (Heater 1990; Vilfan 1996). The demise of the Roman Empire also saw the end of property registration. Land registers at the level of regions and countries began to be reestablished in Europe during the sixteenth century. European countries that stand out in terms of either an early introduction of the land register or its quality, which makes 85 Matej Gabrovec, Ivan Bicik, Blaz Komac, Land registers as a source of studying long-term land-use changes it possible to study land use at least from the nineteenth century onward, are presented below. The Netherlands was among the first to introduce a land register, and its introduction was connected with collecting taxes for the maintenance of dikes in the polders and acquiring new land. On 1:3,000 to 1:5,000 cadastral maps from the first third of the sixteenth century showing the area north of the town of Alkmaar, different colors were also used to indicate land use (Kain and Baigent 1992). A land register covering the entire national territory was produced in the first half of the nineteenth century, featuring 1:1,250 to 1:5,000 maps and providing information on the owner, land use, quality, and yield for each parcel (Kain and Baigent 1992). A very long tradition of property taxation and assessment is typical of Sweden (Mansberger 2015). The Swedish land survey was established in 1628 under King Gustavus Adolphus. The 1636 instructions gave surveyors a detailed color scheme in order to standardize presentation on the maps: »Cultivated fields were to be colored gray, meadows green, mosses yellow, fences black, lakes light blue, rivers dark blue, boundaries red, forests dark green, and stony slopes white« (Kain and Baigent 1992, 54). The maps were produced at a scale of 1:5,000 and 1:3,333. The forests and wasteland around the villages were not included, and therefore a large part of the national territory was not surveyed (Kain and Baigent 1992). At the time it was created, the Swedish land register was the most extensive cartographic work in Europe. Unlike modern aerial photos, the cadastral maps it contained make it possible to analyze land-use changes over a period of three hundred years. Cousins (2001) conducted such an analysis on a 2.2 x 2.8km area in Nynas south of Stockholm. In France, discussions on designing a land register began as early as the end of the eighteenth century and systematic work began in 1807 after the relevant law was adopted. Work was completed in 1850. Cadastral maps used various scales, ranging from 1:500 to 1:5,000, and the textual part of the land register also contained summary tables on land use in individual municipalities. The land register has been used as a source for several studies of changes in land use as well as visible aspects of the rural landscape (Clout and Sutton 1969). Perpilou was the first researcher in France to base his analyses of land-use changes on cadastral maps, such as the one presented in his study of the Limousin region, which he conducted based on summary tables on land use in nine hundred municipalities (Perpilou 1959). Juillard and Angrand (1961) produced maps of nineteenth- and twentieth-century land use in eastern France based on the textual part of the land register. A comprehensive volume about land-use changes in nineteenth-century France was authored by Clout (1983). Gabet (1965) used the cadastral maps for geomorphological research - specifically, for measuring cliff retreats. In Denmark, many of the attributes and history of the Napoleonic land registers can be observed. The Danish land register was established in 1844. Its text and maps have been updated continually ever since. The first Danish land register was created in 1688 but it contained no maps. The land was surveyed at a scale of 1:4,000 in the last two decades of the eighteenth century. Each map included a village and the associated cultivated areas. The land register is still used to collect land taxes, but to a much smaller extent because the property tax has been based on the market value of the individual properties since 1903 (Enemark 1992; 1994). In Norway, the most extensive body of historical maps is made up of the cadastral maps designed after the 1857 Land Consolidation Act, which brought about an extensive reorganization of agricultural areas. These 1:2,000 maps make it possible to analyze changes in the cultural landscape (Domaas 2007; Hamre, Domaas and Austad 2007). Unlike France and the Scandinavian countries, during the nineteenth century Germany was not yet united, but consisted of many smaller states. Land-register development varied by state and was influenced by French, Dutch, and Scandinavian models (Kain and Baigent 1992). Based on the cartographic and textual parts of the Bavarian land register, which has been kept continually since the mid-nineteenth century, Bender et al. (2005) analyzed cultural landscape changes and used them to produce a scenario of future development. The Milan land register is the predecessor of the Habsburg land register. Lombardy and the Duchy of Milan were part of the Habsburg Monarchy at that time, and the survey there was carried out from 1720 to 1723, with maps produced at a scale of 1:2,000. During the 1750s, the Theresian Cadaster was designed in the monarchy, followed by the Josephinian Cadaster between 1785 and 1788. It was completed in four years; however, the surveys were conducted hurriedly with the main objective of determining the areas of land parcels, and no or only limited graphical documentation was provided (Lisec and Navratil 2014). The Josephinian Cadaster provided the basis for the Franciscean Cadaster, which is examined by the articles featured in this special issue and presented below. 86 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 3 Articles What all the articles in this special issue have in common is the Franciscean Cadaster, often also referred to as the Stable Cadaster. It was created in the Habsburg hereditary lands between 1818 and 1828 following the reforms introduced by Emperor Francis I and it succeeded the Josephinian Cadaster. This cadaster is the key data source for the territory of the former Habsburg Monarchy. It was produced in the first half of the nineteenth century for the Austrian part of the empire, which included what is now Austria, Czechia, and Slovenia, and parts of what is now Italy, Croatia, Poland, Ukraine, and Romania, and in the second half of the nineteenth century for the Hungarian part, which included what is now Hungary and Croatia, and parts of Romania, Serbia, and Slovenia (Lisec and Ferlan 2017). The importance of this cadaster as the source for studying the nineteenth-century cultural landscape and its later transformations is demonstrated by Petek and Urbanc (2004), and Bicík et al. (2015), and an overview of literature on land-use changes based on this source was prepared by Gabrovec and Kumer (2019). The first article in this special issue of Acta geographica Slovenica, titled »Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia « (Bicík, Gabrovec and Kupková 2019), is the first comparative study of land-use changes in two central European countries over a period of two centuries using uniform quantitative methods. The driving forces of land-use change have been comparable in both countries. However, the Czech cultural landscape was more significantly transformed due to nationalization and collectivization, whereas in Slovenia fragmented private property contributed to preserving nineteenth-century cultural landscape elements. The article helps better understand past, present and future land-use changes in central Europe. The second article, titled »Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions« (Bicík, Kupková and Boudny 2019), discusses the long-term impact of borders and border regimes on land use. The authors used the Czech-German and Czech-Austrian border to present land-use changes in nine thousand territorial units between 1845 and 2012, and they also conducted a pilot study of a locality in the eastern part of the Krkonose Mountains. They established a significant increase in forests and grasslands accompanied by an extreme decrease in arable land in the second half of the twentieth century, driven by the political changes after 1945 and 1989. After 1990, the landscape changes in the Czech Republic were greater than those in Austria and Germany. The article »Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes« (Kladnik et al. 2019) presents long-term land-use changes in eight areas of various Slovenian landscapes. It offers a comparison of changes on terraced and non-terraced land from the early nineteenth century to the present and a typological classification of land-use change; specifically, extensification, afforestation, grass overgrowth, intensification, and urbanization. It demonstrates large differences in influencing factors and the rate of land-use change between terraced and non-terraced land, which reflect both economic growth and the general economic and political-administrative situation in Slovenian regions. In the article »Assessment of land-use changes and their impacts on ecosystem services in two Slovenian rural landscapes« (Ribeiro and Smid Hribar 2019), the authors use two pilot areas to explore the links between land use, landscape changes, and ecosystem services. They state that, from the perspective of ecosystem services, intensification and overgrowth should be restricted. The paper presents an approach that can be used as a support tool for decision-making in managing and governing landscapes. The article »Monitoring land-use change using selected indices« (Foski and Zavodnik Lamovsek 2019) presents various land-use change indices developed by the authors or derived from landscape metrics. They were calculated for five selected sites in agricultural land (i.e., fields) for the time when the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced and for 2015. It was found that the numerical values mostly reflect the visually detected land-use changes well and show land-use fragmentation. The indices could be used as an objective approach in systems monitoring land-use change. 4 Conclusion National authorities introduce land registers to assess and tax property. Information on land use, which is an important cultural landscape element, is an integral part of these registers. Except for rare previous examples in smaller areas, European countries began introducing land registers at the national level during 87 Matej Gabrovec, Ivan Bicik, Blaz Komac, Land registers as a source of studying long-term land-use changes the eighteenth century, but it was not until the nineteenth century that the first countries began introducing land registers with appertaining maps for their entire national territory. The Habsburg Monarchy stands out among these for having produced the high-quality Franciscean Cadaster, or Stable Cadaster, for the Austrian part of the monarchy in the first half of the nineteenth century. This cadaster thus shows the cultural landscape at a preindustrial stage, which is why it can also be described as a traditional cultural landscape. The central topic covered in this issue is land-use change or the transformation of the traditional cultural landscape, with all articles using the Franciscean Cadaster as their primary data source. Cases are presented from Slovenia and Czechia. The authors used data from both the textual and cartographic parts of the cadaster. The textual part was used in articles dealing with the national and regional levels, and the cartographic part was used in case studies at the level of individual municipalities. All the articles deal with the countryside, which predominated in the nineteenth century. Agricultural land use is thus at the forefront of the studies presented, with authors interested not only in the changes in the area and share of individual land-use types, but also the fragmentation of land use and its connection with other factors, such as relief characteristics, cultivated terraces, and state borders. Land use is connected with the ecosystem services and the level of biodiversity in individual landscapes, both of which can increase or decrease with changes in land use. ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS: This work was supported by project GA ČR GBP410/12/G113 »Historical Geography Research Centre« (Faculty of Science, Charles University in Prague and The Institute of History, Academy of Sciences of the Czech Republic, v. v. i.) and by the research programme Geography of Slovenia (P6-0101) financed by the Slovenian Research Agency. 5 References Bender, O., Boehmerb, H. J., Jens, D., Schumacher, K. P. 2005. Using GIS to analyse long-term cultural landscape change in Southern Germany. Landscape and Urban Planning 70-1. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/j.landurbplan.2003.10.008 Bičik, I., Gabrovec, M., Kupkova, L. 2019: Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between the Czechia and Slovenia. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https//:doi.org/10.3986/AGS.7005 Bičik, I., Jeleček L., Štepanek, V. 2001: Land-use changes and their social driving forces in Czechia in the 19th and 20th centuries. Land Use Policy 18-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/S0264-8377(00)00047-8 Bičik, I., Kupkova L., Jeleček L., Kabrda J., Štych, P., Janoušek, Z.,Winklerova, J. 2015: Land use changes in the Czech Republic 1845-2010. Cham, Heidelberg, New York, Dordrecht, London. Bičik, I., Kupkova, L., Boudny, Z. 2019: Long-term land-use/land cover changes in Czechia's border regions. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.7191 Clout H. D. 1983: The land of France 1815-1914. London. Clout H. D., Sutton, K. 1969: The »Cadastre« as a Source for French Rural Studies. Agricultural History 43-2. Coughlan, M. R., Nelson, D. R. 2018: Influences of Native American land use on the Colonial Euro-American settlement of the South Carolina Piedmont. PLOS ONE 13-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1371/ j ournal.pone. 0195036 Cousins, S. A. O. 2001: Analysis of land-cover transitions based on 17th and 18th century cadastral maps and aerial photographs. Landscape Ecology 16-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1023/A:1008108704358 Domaas, S. T., 2007. The reconstruction of past patterns of tilled fields from historical cadastral maps using GIS. Landscape Research 32-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/01426390601097511 Enemark, S., 1992. Land use planning strategies - towards comprehensive environmental control. Proceedings of the FIG Seminar on Land Use Decision Making. Madrid. Enemark, S., 1994. Evaluation of the Cadastral Reform in Denmark - Training the old lady for the skateboard. Proceedings of Commission 7, XX Congress of the International Federation of Surveyors, Melbourne. Foški, M., Duric, N., Tič, K., Triglav Čekada, M. 2018: Primerjalna analiza modelov pokrovnosti in rabe zemljišč v izbranih državah. Geografski vestnik 90-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/GV90106 Foški, M., Zavodnik Lamovšek, A. 2019: Monitoring land use change using selected indices. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.5276 88 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Gabet, C. 1965: La pointe du Chay. Norois 47. DOI : https://doi.org/10.3406/noroi.1965.1532 Gabrovec, M., Kladnik, D. 1997: Some new aspects of land use in Slovenia. Geografski zbornik 38. Gabrovec, M., Kumer, P. 2019: Land-use changes in Slovenia from the Franciscean Cadaster until today. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.4892 Geršič, M., Gabrovec, M., Zwitter, Ž. 2018: Primerjava kulturne pokrajine Hraških listnekov in tamkajšnjega kmetovanja v prvi polovici 19. stoletja in danes. Geografski vestnik 90-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/ GV90104 Hamre, L. N., Domaas, S. T., Austad I., Rydgren, K. 2007: Land-cover and structural changes in a western Norwegian cultural landscape since 1865, based on an old cadastral map and a field survey. Landscape Ecology 22-10. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s10980-007-9154-y Heater, D. B. 1990: Citizenship: The civic ideal in world history, politics and education. London. Ilešič, S. 1950: Sistemi poljske razdelitve na Slovenskem (La Physionomie parcellaire des champs en Slovénie). Ljubljana. Juillard, E., Angrand, J.-P. 1961: L'utilisation du sol dans les départements de l'Est de la France du XIXe au XXe siècle : le Bas-Rhin et la Moselle. Revue Géographique de l'Est 1-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3406/ rgest.1961.1759 Kain, R. J. P., Baigent E. 1992: The cadastral map in the service of the state: A history of property mapping. Chicago. Kladnik, D., Geršič, M., Pipan, P., Volk Bahun, M. 2019: Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.6988 Komac, B. 2009: Social memory and geographical memory of natural disasters. Acta geographica Slovenica 49-1. Ljubljana. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS49107 Larsson, G. 1996. Land registration and cadastral systems. Kuala Lumpur. Lisec, A., Ferlan, M. 2017: 200 let od začetka parcelno orientiranega katastra na Slovenskem (200 years from the origins of the parcel oriented land cadastre in Slovenian lands). Geodetski vestnik 61-1. Lisec, A., Navratil, G. 2014: The Austrian land cadastre: From the earliest beginnings to the modern land information system. Geodetski vestnik 58-3. Mansberger, R. 2015: Bewertung der Immobilien in Schweden. Liegenschaft und Wert. Wien, Graz. Manville, P. B. 1990: The origins of citizenship in Ancient Athens. Princeton. Medved, J. 1970: Spremembe v izrabi zemljišča in preslajanje kmečkega prebivalstva v Sloveniji v zadnjih dveh desetletjih. Geografski vestnik 42. Perpillou, A. 1959: L'utilisation du sol par l'agriculture sur la façade atlantique entre Loire et Gironde. Bulletin de la Section de géographie 72. Petek, F., Urbanc, M. 2004: The Franziscean Land Cadastre as a key to understanding the 19th-century cultural landscape in Slovenia. Acta geographica Slovenica 44-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS44104. Ramankutty, N., Graumlich, L., Achard, F., Alves, D., Chhabra, A., DeFries, R. S., Foley, J. A., Geist, H. et al. 2006: Global Land-Cover Change: Recent Progress, Remaining Challenges. Land-Use and Land-Cover Change. Berlin, Heidelberg, New York. Ribeiro, D., Šmid Hribar, M. 2019: Assessment of land-use changes and their impacts on ecosystem services in two Slovenian rural landscapes. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/ AGS.6636 Šmid Hribar, M., Geršič, M., Pipan, P., Repolusk, P., Tiran, J., Topole, M., Ciglič, R. 2017: Cultivated terraces in Slovenian landscapes. Acta geographica Slovenica 57-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.4597 Špulerova, J., Dobrovodska, M., Štefunkova, D., Kenderessy, P., Izsoff, P. 2017: Terraced landscapes in Slovakia. Acta geographica Slovenica 57-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.4674 Vilfan, S. 1996: Zgodovinska pravotvornost in Slovenci. Ljubljana. Yang, Y., Zhang, S., Yang, J. Chang, L., Bu, K., Xing, X. 2014: A review of historical reconstruction methods of land use/land cover. Journal of Geographical Sciences 24-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s11442-014-1117-z 89 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 91-117 LONG-TERM LAND-USE CHANGES: A COMPARISON BETWEEN CZECHIA AND SLOVENIA Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova Many elements of the 19th century land use patterns are preserved at Sorsko polje Plain in Slovenia. Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova, Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.7005 UDC: 913:711.14:63(437.3+497.4)«18/20« COBISS: 1.01 Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia ABSTRACT: Detailed information about land use is available from the mid-nineteenth century onward for the countries of the former Habsburg Monarchy. For Slovenia and Czechia, databases have been created that make it possible to analyze the period from the first half of the nineteenth century to the beginning of the twenty-first century. The processes of changing land use were comparable during the period examined. Nonetheless, the cultural landscape in Czechia was significantly more transformed. Because of the nationalization of land after the Second World War and the establishment of state-owned collective farms and cooperatives, today large complexes of farmland predominate, whereas in Slovenia fragmented properties still predominate, and the cultural landscape therefore preserves many more elements from the nineteenth century. KEY WORDS: geography, agrarian geography, historical geography, land-use changes, Franciscean cadaster, Slovenia, Czechia Dolgoročne spremembe rabe zemljišč: Primerjava med Češko in Slovenijo POVZETEK: Za države nekdanje Habsburške monarhije so podrobni podatki o rabi zemljišč na voljo od sredine 19. stoletja. V Sloveniji in na Češkem je urejena podatkovna baza, ki omogoča analize za obdobje od prve polovice 19. do začetka 21. stoletja. Procesi sprememb rabe zemljišč so bili v obravnavanem obdobju primerljivi. Kljub temu pa se je kulturna pokrajina na Češkem bistveno bolj preobrazila. Zaradi podržavljenja zemljišč po 2. svetovni vojni in ustanavljanja državnih kmetijskih posestev in zadrug danes prevladujejo veliki kompleksi kmetijskih zemljišč, medtem ko v Sloveniji še vedno prevladuje razdrobljena posest, v kulturni pokrajini je zato ohranjenih mnogo več elementov iz 19. stoletja. KLJUČNE BESEDE: geografija, agrarna geografija, historična geografija, spremembe rabe zemljišč, franciscejski kataster, Slovenija, Češka Ivan Bmk Charles University in Prague, Faculty of Science, Department of Social Geography and Regional Development bicik@natur.cuni.cz Matej Gabrovec Research Center of the Slovenian Academy of Sciences and Arts, Anton Melik Geographical Institute matej@zrc-sazu.si Lucie Kupková Charles University in Prague, Faculty of Science, Department of Applied Geoinformatics and Cartography lucie.kupkova@natur.cuni.cz The paper was submitted for publication on March 8th, 2019. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 8. marca 2019. 92 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction Analyses to date of changes in long-term land use, which cover a period of at least two hundred years, are limited to the territories of individual countries (Himiyama et al. 2001; Gillmor 2001; Bicík et al. 2015; Gabrovec and Kumer 2019). There is a lack of studies comparing changes in land use across multiple countries for such a timespan. This article addresses this research gap by comparing long-term land-use changes in Slovenia and Czechia. These two countries were selected because databases on land use are available for their territories; these databases were created based on archival cadastral material and they cover the period from the first half of the nineteenth century to the beginning of the twenty-first century. The data are available at the level of cadastral units, and analyses of land-use changes during this period have also been published (Bicík, Jelecek and Stepánek 2001; Bicík et al. 2015; Gabrovec and Kumer 2019). These publications have shown the processes of land-use change using various statistical methods, supplemented by extensive cartographic material. These findings are only conditionally comparable because of the use of different methods. In this article, the databases for both countries are arranged in the same manner, which means that various land-use categories have been combined into the same groups. For the period from the first half of the nineteenth century to the beginning of the twenty-first century, a typology developed by Czech geographers (Bicík and Jelecek 2009) was used to show land-use changes, and an index of change was calculated that has also already been used multiple times in Czechia (Bicík et al. 2015). This makes direct comparisons possible, and the differences are explained below through various driving forces behind the changes resulting from differences in both countries' economic and political development, as well as their natural features. Outside of Slovenia and Czechia, studies of land-use changes based on detailed cadastral data for the time period studied are available only at the level of individual case studies (Cousins 2001; Kanianska et al. 2014; Harvey, Kaim and Gajda 2014; Prokop 2018), which make it possible to identify individual processes, but do not allow analyses or determination of patterns at the country level. Many case studies have also been carried out in Slovenia and Czechia (Azman Momirski and Gabrovec 2014; Bicík, Kupková and Stych 2012; Gabrovec 1995; Gabrovec, Komac and Zorn 2012; Mares, Rasin and Pipan 2013; Pausic and Carni 2012; Petek and Urbanc 2004; Rasín and Chromy 2010; Smid Hribar 2016; Stych et al. 2012; Gersic, Gabrovec and Zwitter; 2iberna 2018), and these allow a more detailed explanation of the driving forces behind land-use changes. 2 Methods The index of change (Bicík and Kupková 2002; Bicík et al. 2015) was used in our study. It is an aggregate index and indicates the intensity of land-use changes (in %) over a certain period of time; it does not, however, assess the »quality« (structure) of such changes. ICa-B =100- — -- ICA B is the index of change between year A and year B; n indicates the number of land-use classes; P¡A is the proportion of relevant land-use class at the beginning of the period examined, and P¡B is the same proportion at the end. The higher the index of change, the more intensive the land-use change in the area examined. This index ranges from 0 to 100 and - put in a simple way - indicates the proportion of area where any land-use change occurred, based on a comparison of the beginning and end (changes that may occur during the period examined are not reflected). Territorial »shifts« without a change in size are also ignored, although these are relatively frequent, especially in the case of agricultural land. In this article, five land-use classes are taken into consideration: arable land, permanent cultures, permanent grassland, forested areas, and other areas. The unit of analysis is cadastral municipalities or, in the Czech case, basic territorial units, which are comprised of one or more cadastral municipalities. The Slovenian and Czech land-use categories differ somewhat in their details. Nonetheless, there are no major difficulties in combining them into five identical land-use classes. The greatest difference between the Slovenian 93 Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova, Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia and Czech categorization (Bicik et al. 2015; LUCC Czechia 2018) is in protected areas. This was a special category in the Czech case in 2010 that was included among other areas, and in Slovenia this category does not exist; with regard to land cover, protected areas are included among the other areas only in the case of land above the tree line, otherwise they are primarily classified as permanent grassland or forest areas. Aggregate changes in land-use structure can be presented in a number of typologies. The one used in this article is based on areal increases (or decreases) in selected land-use classes (Bicik and Kupkova 2002; Bicik et al. 2015). The classes that show an increase or decrease over the period of time examined are marked + or -; by using combinations of increases and decreases (related to different classes), various types are created. Changes in the three aggregate classes (agricultural land, forest areas, and other areas) over time are compared in this manner. To sum up, this typology is a simple one and indicates directions only, but not any significance of the changes observed. 3 Driving forces of land-use changes »Change in land use and land cover can be conceptualized as the result of the operation ofpressures or dri-vingforces: an impulse is applied, and a change ofstate results« (Mather 2006, 179). Five factors commonly appear: population, economic development, technology, institutions, and culture (Mather 2006). In the case of Slovenia and Czechia, the driving forces were similar in certain historical periods and different in others. Similar processes were characteristic until the First World War, when both countries were part of the Austrian Monarchy, and after 2004, when both countries joined the European Union. The driving forces differred the most in the second half of the twentieth century. Even though both countries had a communist government, their economic policies and especially their agricultural policies differed significantly. The most important trend during the period examined was the growing importance of economic and social factors in the context of rapidly spreading technological and social innovations. Regarding the value of land as a natural resource, in fertile regions the economic aspects prevailed, and in less fertile areas the environmental aspect was the most important one (Bicik and Jelecek 2005; Bicik et al. 2015). 3.1 From the nineteenth century to the First World War The land-use data from the first half of the nineteenth century show land-use structure as a result of centuries-long gradual agricultural use before industrialization. The economic and technological limits of the preindustrial production mode were behind the relatively low regional differences. Transport remained slow and costly, and long-distance trade and competition were limited. Most products were consumed locally, and the spatial division of labor and specialization remained weak. Most material goods, energy, and so on circulated within a limited space only (i.e., farms and villages). Consequently, different land-use types had to be spatially interconnected. Everywhere, including in mountainous regions, it was essential to possess enough arable land (to provide food), grassland (for livestock), and forests (to provide fuel and construction material) (Hampl 2000; Jepsen et al. 2015; Krausmann et al. 2003; Bicik et al. 2015). The revolutionary movements of 1848-1849 resulted in the end of feudalism: serfdom was abolished, the industrial revolution was accomplished, and the path toward a new social and economic organization, freemarket capitalism, was opened. Much of the land that had previously been owned (and rented out) by landlords became the property of small farmers (Bicik et al. 2015). The long-term increase in arable land came to an end in both countries at the end of the nineteenth century. Industrialization took place more slowly in Slovenian territory than in Czech territory, and so with the growing population there was an increase in agrarian overpopulation in Slovenia, which reached its apex at the end of the nineteenth century (Petek 2005). In Slovenia, at the end of nineteenth century most of the population still earned a living through agriculture, standing at 76% in 1890. Despite labor-intensive agricultural production, it was impossible to feed the entire population and there were not many jobs outside of farming, and so there was significant emigration, especially to North America (Kladnik and Andric 2013). Industrialization and agricultural intensification in Czech territory on the contrary caused development of urbanization, movement of rural population to the cities and increase of working class in the cities. 94 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 3.2 The interwar period Following the war, Czechoslovakia was among the newly emerged nation states. Slovenia became part of the new Kingdom of Serbs, Croats, and Slovenes, which was renamed the Kingdom of Yugoslavia in 1929. One quarter of the territory of present-day Slovenia belonged to Italy until the end of the Second World War. The structure of Czech (or Czechoslovak) agriculture changed significantly after the country's independence. The Land Reform Act was passed in 1919, and transfers of land started in 1920. The new laws stipulated that landowners could possess a maximum of 150 hectares of agricultural land, or 250 hectares of land altogether. The excess land was purchased by the state. The land reform of the 1920s fundamentally changed the land ownership patterns and tenure in rural areas. In the past, the large estates in general had been focused on cash crops. In contrast, most new landowners were forced to become subsistence farmers and had to labor intensively in the fields. This is why the amount of arable land slightly increased and permanent grassland decreased in terms of size in the mid-1920s. The driving forces that influenced the economy and society also underwent substantial changes. Agriculture was less important; industry and to some extent also services became the leading sectors. These trends are reflected in the changing structure of the workforce by sectors. Residential and industrial developments were booming, especially in urban areas. Consequently, built-up and remaining areas increased. However, this was a regionally unbalanced process (Bicik et al. 2015). In Slovenia, agriculture was characterized by land fragmentation, as seen in the smaller average size of farms and the growing number of plots of land on farms. In 1931 the average farm measured 8.3 hectares. Market production was modest. The most market-oriented sectors were viticulture and fruit growing, and hop production continued to remain profitable, whereas silk production died out during this period. The entire period was also characterized by considerable industrialization in Slovenia (Kladnik and Andric 2013). 3.3 From the Second World War to 1990 From 1948 to 1990, Czechoslovakia was ruled by a communist government. It is important to understand that all crucial decisions were de facto made by the Central Committee of the Czechoslovak Communist Party, which influenced the social and economic conditions, including land-use patterns. The most important land-use changes during the last 170 years took place between 1948 and 1960. This was a time of major economic and social changes, which included the effects of the expulsion of ethnic Germans, a new political and geopolitical orientation and economic system, large-scale industrialization, introduction of collective farming, emergence of military training areas, and the depopulation of rural areas (Bicik and Jelecek 2005). The communist government relied on outdated, inefficient energy and raw materials, and a very demanding industrial structure that could not compete with advanced western European countries. Shortly after the communist coup d'état (in February 1948), the Iron Curtain fell across the western border, large tracts of land became inaccessible, and in many cases new settlers had to move back. In this case, the effects on land-use patterns were great and almost immediate. Farming was severely restricted in areas along the border (only state-owned farms were allowed) and was often completely forbidden. Much of the western border is located at rather high elevations (25% of border regions are over 700 m), despite the fact that the German-speaking population had formerly intensively cultivated these regions. After the expulsion of the German population from 1945 to 1947, hundreds of villages and towns (up to 1,200) ceased to exist, and much of the arable land was completely abandoned. Communist reforms of Czechoslovak agriculture were carried out in three stages. First, the land previously owned by ethnic Germans and Nazi sympathizers was confiscated. In 1947 and 1948, mostly forests were nationalized. Finally, the new land reform that started in March 1948 confiscated all properties over fifty hectares. Even after these dramatic shifts, some 60% of farmland was still owned by private farmers - until the rise of cooperatives. Private farmers were encouraged, often violently, to join cooperatives and state farms; this process happened virtually in every single village. Later, cooperatives were gradually amalgamated into large units. Collectivization was rapid in the early 1950s, slowed down after 1955/1956, and came to an end in 1960. By the end of the 1980s, cooperatives and state farms managed 98.5% of all agricultural land. Cooperatives and state farms gradually introduced large-scale agricultural production on amalgamated fields. Settlement patterns changed fundamentally after the Second World War, and the state reacted by introducing a new official settlement network. 95 Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova, Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia Starting in the early 1970s, it attempted to concentrate the dispersed population into so-called central settlements. Large-scale industrialization and intensive exploitation of raw materials were among the most important driving forces in the landscape during this period. Large residential projects, usually prefabricated blocks of flats, were built in mining and industrial regions to provide accommodation for the workforce, mostly migrating from rural areas. These new massive urban developments appeared almost exclusively on greenfields (Bicik et al. 2015). In Slovenia, agricultural and rural development following the Second World War resulted from the impact of diffuse industrialization, which fostered urbanization. This urbanization remained hidden to some degree, however, due to extensive daily commuting. The split with the Soviet Union and its satellites in 1948 had a significant impact on Yugoslavia's development of an independent approach to communism. Despite agrarian reform pressures and other ongoing pressures for nationalization, in Yugoslavia nationalization was only carried out on a small scale, and in Slovenia the proportion of private land never fell below 85%. The agrarian reform act of December 1945 enacted the seizure without compensation of all land owned by »capitalist« landowners (i.e., banks, companies, joint-stock companies, monasteries, and churches) that encompassed more than twenty-five hectares of cultivated land. Other farm owners with more than twenty-five hectares of land received monetary compensation for their surplus land that was seized, as did nonfarming households, which were allowed to keep only three hectares of cultivated land. It was envisaged that compensation for the seized land would be paid out in the amount of one year's yield per hectare. Half of the land acquired in this way was allotted to people without land and other poor farmers with less than 2.5 hectares of land. The size of private farms was limited to ten hectares of cultivated land after 1953 (Kladnik and Andric 2013; Cepic 1995). In the 1973, the maximum permitted landholding in Slovenia was increased to twenty hectares in mountain and karst areas (Avsec 1988). Because of the small and fragmented properties, income from farming was not sufficient to make a living, and so farmers started to take jobs in industry, working their land in the afternoon and on weekends. An increasingly large stratum of part-time farmers took shape. Their income from nonagricultural activity was largely invested in modernizing the farms. Job opportunities in industry and other activities for the rural population prevented the abandonment of farmland and made it possible to preserve farming activity and the rural cultural landscape (Klemencic 1968; Klemencic 1974; Logar 2013; Razpotnik Viskovic 2013; 2015). In an effort to offset the negative impact of permanent land loss due to urbanization, an extensive program of land reclamation was begun in the 1970s, the centerpiece of which was irrigation and drainage, which was ecologically highly controversial (Kladnik and Andric 2013). Due to these processes, in 1990 the Slovenian rural landscape was completely different from the Czech one. Whereas large state-owned properties predominated in what is now the Czech Republic, in Slovenia a fragmented property composition was preserved that did not differ significantly from that of the nineteenth century. 3.4 After 1990 After 1990, full-scale political and economic liberalization was achieved, the central European countries became EU and NATO members, and standard capitalist and democratic regimes were established based on a market economy. In Czechia, the former state-owned farms have been transformed into limited companies through privatization. The communist-style collective farms have been transformed into cooperatives managed by landowners that nowadays constitute relatively functional units. People do not have an affl-iation with the land. In most cases, the new owners that regained their land through restitution did not start farming but instead rented the land out. The greatest share of agricultural land is managed either by limited companies (46%) or by transformed cooperatives (23%). In the European context, these companies are rather large, which allows cost-effective farming and competitiveness. As Havlicek (2018) points out also a large part of land seized by communist regime from churches between 1948 and 1989 was returned to the churches mainly in 2014 and 2015. Overall, the period after 1990 was characterized by a decline in total agricultural production. Czech agriculture as a whole continues to profit from EU membership and from the subsidies in the framework of the Common Agricultural Policy. The continuing decrease in arable land is the most important land-use change after 1990. In most cases, arable land was converted into permanent grassland, also (sub)urbanization was important process of landscape change in this period (Bicik etal. 2015). 96 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Slovenia has been caught up in a storm of rapid tertiarization and, in the past two decades, also globalization, which has exposed the great vulnerability of Slovenian agriculture that does not meet the agricultural production standards in developed countries around the world. With accession to the European Union, state protectionism was also dropped, and Slovenian farmers found themselves in a tough battle to survive on the global market. This started with independence of Slovenia (in 1990). By far the most important incentive that still motivates farmers to continue their rural way of life is preserving their farm tradition, something that has usually provided work for several generations. Other reasons include enjoyment of farm work, the desire to have one's own produce, and attachment to the land. Regardless of these motives to preserve agricultural land use, financial instruments as part of European Union rural development measures have a significant impact. One of the mega-drivers preventing more efficient use of farmland remains land fragmentation, but nonetheless there is a slow decrease in the number of farms and an increase in the concentration of land. There is also growing interest in land consolidation and agglomeration (Kladnik and Andrič 2013; Lampič et al. 2017). 4 Results 4.1 Overview of land use changes A comparison of land-use changes in Slovenia and Czechia (Figures 1 and 2) shows that the processes in both countries were similar. During individual periods, the shares of individual types of use changed in the same direction and in comparable dimensions. However, the initial composition of land use already significantly differed in the nineteenth century, which was a result of natural geographical conditions. Thus, in Czechia the share of arable land is approximately twice as large as in Slovenia, and the share of forested land and permanent grasslands is correspondingly smaller (Gabrovec and Kladnik 1997; Gabrovec, Petek and Kladnik 2001; Bičik et al. 2015). 4.2 Index of change In both countries, the index of change (Figures 3 and 4) shows a similar picture, with the highest values in two types of areas. It seems reasonable that the highest values are recorded in the core areas with intensive social and economic development. However, the majority of peripheral, mountainous border regions have also witnessed rather intensive changes. In both countries, the greatest changes took place in areas from which the ethnic German population moved or was expelled during or immediately after the Second World War. In Slovenia this is the Kočevje area in the southeast part of the country (Mares, Rasin and Pipan 2013), and in Czechia the hilly Sudetenland along the border with Germany. In addition, in Slovenia the Kras Plateau in the southwest part of the country should be highlighted. The Franciscean cadaster shows that among all Slovenian regions natural forest vegetation was cleared the most on the Kras Plateau, which was at that time synonymous with the barren and desolate karst landscape. Today forest covers more than half of the Kras Plateau, which is the result of planned reforestation at the end of the nineteenth century (Kladnik, Petek and Urbanc 2008; Kladnik 2011; Zorn, Kumer and Ferk 2015) followed by natural succession of meadows and pastures. 4.3 Typology of land-use changes The maps of the typology of land-use changes in Slovenia (Figure 5) and Czechia (Figure 6) show a roughly similar picture, in which Class C predominates in both, showing a simultaneous increase in forested areas and other areas; that is, a combination of urbanization and afforestation. The next, with a much smaller share of cadastral municipalities, is Class A, corresponding to an increase in other areas - that is, primarily built-up land, and at the same time a decrease in farmland and forested areas. In Slovenia, in contrast to Czechia, Class B - which indicates the expansion of forested areas and a simultaneous decrease in farmland and built-up land - corresponds to just under a tenth of cadastral municipalities. In Slovenia, in addition to the Kočevje region, which the ethnic German population was expelled from, this class includes some 97 Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova, Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia Figure 1: Czech land use between 1845 and 2010. Figure 2: Slovenian land use between 1825 and 2012. 98 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 sparsely settled depopulation areas, especially in western Slovenia. This class would also include hilly border areas in Czechia, but in terms of land use much of the forested land there has been classified as protected areas (as mentioned in Section 2), which was included among other areas. In the typology of land-use change these areas are therefore mostly included in Class C. 5 Discussion and conclusion This article is the first comparative study of land-use changes in two central European countries over a period of two centuries using uniform quantitative methods. It uses the index of change and typology of changes based on the calculated increase or decrease in farmland, forested land, and other land. The processes of land-use change were based on the driving forces behind the changes from the first half of the nineteenth century to the present, and these differed the most between the two countries during the twentieth century. The consequence of different agricultural policies in the period after the Second World War is not reflected so much in different land use, but in the different sizes of parcels and the diversity of land use. Although the driving forces behind the changes are presented in the framework of short time periods, land-use changes are cartographically presented and analyzed only between the beginning of their study in the nineteenth century and 2010 or 2012. In the future it would therefore make sense to examine the second half of the twentieth century in greater detail because the processes of change were most intense during this period and at the same time there were also the greatest differences between the two countries. As a result, one would expect greater differences in the processes of land-use changes, but the analysis showed that these were comparable during the period analyzed. Nonetheless, the cultural landscape in the Czech Republic has been visually transformed to a significantly greater extent. Because of the nationalization of land after the Second World War and the establishment of state-owned collective farms and cooperatives, today large complexes of farmland predominate, whereas Slovenia is still characterized by fragmented properties and the cultural landscape therefore preserves many more elements from the nineteenth century. ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS: This work was supported by project GA CR GBP410/12/G113 »Historical Geography Research Centre« (Faculty of Science, Charles University in Prague and The Institute of History, Academy of Sciences of the Czech Republic, v. v. i.) and by the research programme Geography of Slovenia (P6-0101) financed by the Slovenian Research Agency. Figure 3: Index of change between 1825 and 2012 in Slovenian territory. p p. 100 Figure 4: Index of change between 1825 and 2012 in Czech territory. p p. l0l Figure 5: Typology of land-use change in Slovenian territory (1825-2012). p p. 102 Figure 6: Typology of land-use change in Czech territory (1845-2010) (LUCC Czechia 2018). p p. 103 99 Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova, Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia 100 Legend < 14.9 15.0-29.9 30.0-44.9 45.0-59.9 60.0 < /\/ regional border 0 50 Content by: Ivan Bicik, Lucie Kupkova Map by: Lucie Kupkova © 2018, Charles LTniversity Faculty of Science Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova, Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia 102 Increase/decrease of share: 1. agricultural land, 2. forest areas, 3. other areas A - - + B - + - c H D + - - E p + - + + + - w. no data /\/ regional border 0 50 ' km Content by: Ivan Bicík, Lucie Kupková Map by: Lucie Kupková ? 2018, Charles LTniversity Faculty olScience Ivan Bicik, Matej Gabrovec, Lucie Kupkova, Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia 6 References Avsec, F. 1988: Zemljiški maksimum kot omejitev lastninske pravice. Zemljiški maksimum, Raziskave in študije 69. Ljubljana. Ažman Momirski, L., Gabrovec, M. 2014: Changes in land use in the Mediterranean terraced landscapes between 1819 and 2012: the case of two selected villages in Slovenia. Land use, cover changes in selected regions in the world 9. Prague. Bičik, I., Jeleček, L. 2005: Political events factoring into land-use changes in Czechia in the 20th century. Understanding land-use and land-cover change in global and regional context. Enfield. Bičik, I., Jeleček, L. 2009: Land use and landscape changes in Czechia during the period of transition 1990-2007. Geografie 114-4. Bičik, I., Jeleček, L., Štepanek, V. 2001: Land-use changes and their social driving forces in Czechia in the 19th and 20th centuries. Land Use Policy 18-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/S0264-8377(00)00047-8 Bičik, I., Kupkova, L. 2002: Long-term and transformational land use changes in Czechia. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the World 2. Prague. Bičik, I., Kupkova, L., Jeleček, L., Kabrda, J., Štych, P., Janoušek, Z., Winklerova, J. 2015: Land use changes in the Czech Republic 1845-2010. Cham, Heidelberg, New York, Dordrecht, London. Bičik, I., Kupkova, L., Štych, P. 2012: Changes of land use structure in Czechia: From local patterns to a more complex regional organization. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the World 7. Prague. Cousins, S. A. O. 2001: Analysis of land-cover transitions based on 17th and 18th century cadastral maps and aerial photographs. Landscape Ecology 16-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1023/A:1008108704358 Čepič, Z. 1995: Agrarna reforma ni kolonizacija v Sloveniji (1945-1948). Ljubljana. Gabrovec, M. 1995: Dolomite areas in Slovenia with particular consideration of relief and land use. Geografski zbornik 35. Gabrovec, M., Kladnik, D. 1997: Some new aspects of land use in Slovenia. Geografski zbornik 38. Gabrovec, M., Komac, B., Zorn, M. 2012: Vpliv sprememb rabe tal na geomorfne procese v zadnjih stoletjih na primeru Zgornjega Posočja. Dolgoročne spremembe okolja 1. Opera Instituti Archaeologici Sloveniae 25. Ljubljana. Gabrovec, M., Kumer, P. 2019: Land-use changes in Slovenia from the Franciscean Cadaster until today. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.4892 Gabrovec, M., Petek, F., Kladnik, D. 2001: Land use changes in the 20th century in Slovenia. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the World 1. Asahikawa. Geršič, M., Gabrovec, M., Zwitter, Ž. 2018: Primerjava kulturne pokrajine Hraških listnekov in tamkajšnjega kmetovanja v prvi polovici 19. stoletja in danes. Geografski vestnik 90-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/ GV90104 Gillmor, D. A. 2001: Land Use/Cover since the Mid Nineteenth Century in the Republic of Ireland. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the World 1. Asahikawa. Hampl, M. 2000: Reality, society and geographical/environmental organization: searching for an integrated order. Prague. Harvey, F., Kaim, D., Gajda, A. 2014: Analysis of historical change using cadastral materials in the Carpathian foothills. European Journal of Geography 5-3. Havliček, T. 2018: Demarginalization and Church property: The case of Czechia. Nature, tourism and ethnicity as drivers of (de)marginalization. Cham. Himiyama, Y., Arizono, S., Fujita, Y., Todokoro, T. 2001: Land Use/Cover Changes in Japan since the Mid 19th Century. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the World 1. Asahikawa. Jepsen, M. R., Kuemmerle, T., Müller, D., Erb, K., Verburg, P. H., Haberl, H., Vesterager, J. P., Andrič, M., Kladnik, D. et al. 2015: Transitions in European land-management regimes between 1800 and 2010. Land Use Policy 49. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016Zj.landusepol.2015.07.003 Kanianska, R., Kizekova, M., Novaček, J., Zeman, M. 2014: Land-use and land-cover changes in rural areas during different political systems: A case study of Slovakia from 1782 to 2006. Land Use Policy 36. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.landusepol.2013.09.018 Kladnik, D. 2011: Širjenje gozda na krasu kot dejavnik prostorskega razvoja. Geografski vestnik 83-2. 104 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Kladnik, D., Andrič, M. 2013: Slovenia. Volante, Deliverable No. 4.3: Technological, institutional and economic drivers of land use change. Internet: https://www.volante-project.eu/images/stories/DELIVERABLES/ VOLANTE_D4.3_Technological_institutional_and_economic_drivers_of_land_use_change.pdf (3.8.2018). Kladnik, D., Petek, F., Urbanc, M. 2008: Pogozdovanje in ogozdovanje. Kras, Trajnostni razvoj kraške pokrajine. Ljubljana. Klemenčič, M. 1974: Socialna in ekonomska struktura mešanih delavsko-kmečkih gospodinjstev na kmečkih gospodarstvih. Geografski vestnik 46. Klemenčič, V. 1968: Problemi mešane strukture gospodinjstev in kmečkih gospodarstev v Sloveniji. Geografski vestnik 40. Krausmann, F., Haberl, H., Schulz, N. B., Erb, K.-H., Darge, E., Gaube, V. 2003: Land use change and socioeconomic metabolism in Austria, Part I: Driving forces of land-use change: 1950-1995. Land Use Policy 20-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/S0264-8377(02)00048-0 Lampič, B., Bedrač, M., Cunder, T., Klun, M., Mrak, I., Slabe Erker, R. 2017: Trajnostna naravnanost kmetijstva v slovenskih regijah. GeograFF 20. Ljubljana. Logar, E. 2013: Sodobne razvojne smeri polkmetov na primeru Voklega. Dela 39. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.4312/dela.39.4.67-86 LUCC Czechia 2018: Vyzkumne centrum zmen využiti ploch Česka. Internet: https://web.natur.cuni.cz/ ksgrrsek/lucc/index.php/data/ (1.6.2018). Mares, P., Rasin, R., Pipan, P. 2013: Abandoned landscapes of former German settlement in the Czech Republic and in Slovenia. Cultural Severance and the Environment, Environmental History 2. Dordrecht. Mather, A. S. 2006: Driving Forces. Our Earth's changing land, An Encyclopedia of land-use and land-cover change 1.Westport. Paušič, A., Čarni, A. 2012: Landscape transformation in the low karst plain of Bela krajina (SE Slovenia) over the last 220 years. Acta geographica Slovenica 52-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS52102 Petek, F. 2005: Spremembe rabe tal v slovenskem alpskem svetu. Geografija Slovenije 11. Ljubljana. Petek, F., Urbanc, M. 2004: The Franziscean Land Cadastre as a key to understanding the 19th-century cultural landscape in Slovenia. Acta geographica Slovenica 44-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS44104 Prokop, P. 2018: Tea plantations as a driving force of long-term land use and population changes in the Eastern Himalayan piedmont. Land Use Policy 77. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.landusepol.2018.05.035 Rašin, R., Chromy, P. 2010: Land use and land cover development along the Czech-Austrian boundary. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the World 5. Prague. Razpotnik Viskovic, N. 2013: Vloga polkmetij v preobrazbi slovenskih obmestij. Georitem 21. Ljubjana. Razpotnik Viskovic, N. 2015: Evaluating the development potential of farms on urban outskirts : methodology. Acta geographica Slovenica 55-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.704 Šmid Hribar, M. 2016: Varovanje in trajnostni razvoj kulturne pokrajine na primeru Ljubljanskega barja. Georitem 27. Ljubljana. Štych, P., Bičik, I., Spazierova, K., Janoušek, Z., Blaha, J. D. 2012: Case study areas Rudna: Change of land use patterns 1840-2005. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the World 7. Prague. Zorn, M., Kumer, P., Ferk, M. 2015: Od gozda do gozda ali kje je goli, kamniti Kras? Kronika 63. Žiberna, I. 2018: Land use changes in relation to selected physical geographical features from the viewpoint of marginalization - The case of Svečinske Gorice, Slovenia. Nature, Tourism and Ethnicity as Drivers of (De)Marginalization. Cham. 105 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 107-117 LONG-TERM LAND-USE / LAND-COVER CHANGES IN CZECH BORDER REGIONS Lucie Kupkova, Ivan Bicik, Zdenek Boudny Cfzov (German: Zaisa), Moravia: the only remaining part of the Iron Curtain in Czechia. Lucie Kupkova, Ivan Bicik, Zdenek Boudny, Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.7191 UDC: 913:711.14(437.3)«1845/2012« COBISS: 1.02 Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions ABSTRACT: This article describes the long-term development of land use and land cover in Czech border regions from 1845 to 2015. It provides an overview of the main works involving Czech border regions and findings by the Faculty of Science at Charles University. The study used the Land Use / Land Cover Changes Czechia (LUCC Czechia 2018) database with six time horizons (1845, 1896, 1948, 1990, 2000, and 2010) and eight categories of land use for approximately nine thousand territorial units, and CORINE Land Cover data for 1990, 2000, and 2006. It also presents a detailed analysis of land-use and land-cover change in one locality in the eastern part of the Krkonoše (Giant Mountains) range, based on land-registry and field-survey data. Development of the LUCC was influenced by the expulsion of ethnic Germans along the western border after the Second World War. The natural conditions in the Czech border areas were identified as another significant factor influencing changes. Changes influenced by these two factors, in combination with several other drivers, are reflected in changes in proportions of land-use and land-cover categories. In the communist period (1948-1990), a significant increase in forests and grasslands accompanied by an extreme decrease in arable land was documented, and the trend of extensification also continued in the transition period from 1990 to 2010. KEY WORDS: land-use / land-cover change, border regions, driving forces, Czechia Dolgoročne spremembe rabe/pokrovnosti tal na čeških obmejnih območjih POVZETEK: V članku je opisan dolgoročni razvoj rabe in pokrovnosti zemljišč na čeških obmejnih območjih med letoma 1845 in 2015. Predstavljen je pregled glavnih del o čeških obmejnih območjih in izsledkov, do katerih so prišli na Naravoslovni fakulteti Karlove univerze v Pragi. Avtorji so uporabili podatkovno zbirko o spremembah rabe/pokrovnosti tal na Češkem (LUCC Czechia 2018), ki vključuje podatke za šest različnih let (1845, 1896, 1948, 1990, 2000 in 2010) in osem kategorij rabe tal za približno 9000 teritorialnih enot, poleg tega pa so proučili tudi podatke iz podatkovne zbirke CORINE Land Cover za leta 1990, 2000 in 2006. Predstavljena je podrobna analiza sprememb rabe in pokrovnosti zemljišč na območju vzhodnih Krkonošev, izvedena na podlagi podatkov zemljiškega katastra in izsledkov terenske raziskave. Na spremembe rabe in pokrovnosti zemljišč na Češkem je vplival izgon čeških Nemcev z območij ob zahodni meji po drugi svetovni vojni. Drug pomemben dejavnik, ki je vplival na te spremembe, so bile naravne razmere na čeških obmejnih območjih. Spremembe, na katere sta ta dva dejavnika vplivala v kombinaciji z več drugimi dejavniki, se odražajo v spremembi deleža posameznih kategorij rabe in pokrovnosti zemljišč. V obdobju med letoma 1948 in 1990 se je močno povečal delež gozdov in travnatih površin, hkrati pa se je precej zmanjšal delež njiv. Ekstenzifikacija se je nadaljevala tudi v obdobju preobrazbe med letoma 1990 in 2010. KLJUČNE BESEDE: spremembe rabe/pokrovnosti tal, obmejna območja, gonilne sile, Češka Lucie Kupkova Charles University in Prague, Faculty of Science, Department of Applied Geoinformatics and Cartography lucie.kupkova@natur.cuni.cz Ivan Bičik, Zdenek Boudny Charles University in Prague, Faculty of Science, Department of Social Geography and Regional Development bicik@natur.cuni.cz, boudnyz @natur.cuni.cz The paper was submitted for publication on October 17th, 2018. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 17. oktobra 2018. 108 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction The article deals with Czech border areas with Austria and Germany where the Iron Curtain was built after the Second World War. The Iron Curtain was a strictly guarded border between the democratic countries of western Europe and the communist states of eastern Europe. The protection of the border also included measures that fundamentally influenced the lives of people on both sides of the border. The fall of the Iron Curtain in 1990 created initial conditions for human migration and cross-border cooperation. These changes triggered economic development in the border regions. Consequently, land-use changes occurred in the border landscape straddling the Iron Curtain. These changes were analyzed along the entire line of the Iron Curtain in Europe by Kupkova, Bicik, and Najman (2013). In the Czech lands, the changes relating to Iron Curtain were combined with those resulting from the expulsion of roughly three million ethnic Germans between 1945 and 1946 (Bicik and Kabrda 2007; Bicik and Stepanek 1994; Rasin and Chromy 2010; Mares, Rasin and Pipan 2013). Studies of landscape changes in the Czech borderland can be divided into two groups. The first ones are based on land-registry data. Differences in land-use changes on both sides of the Iron Curtain are presented in the timespan between 1845 and 2000 (Bicik et al. 2010; Bicik and Kabrda 2007; Bicik and Stepanek 1994; Stepanek 1992; Kucera and Kucerova 2012; Rasin and Chromy 2010). The second ones are based on CORINE Land Cover data and deal with landcover changes after the removal of the Iron Curtain (Najman 2008; Kupkova, Bicik and Najman 2013). This article presents spatial transformation of the borderland using both methods and data. Based on an overview of the studies mentioned above, this article describes specific aspects of land-use change in the unique area of Czech border regions that were affected by several distinctive driving forces over the last two centuries. 2 Methods and data The analysis is mainly based on a land-use database prepared at the geographic departments of the Faculty of Science at Charles University in Prague (LUCC Czechia 2018). The database is based on a cadaster (Jelecek 2006) and comprises eight land-use categories for roughly nine thousand stable territorial units (STUs; Bicik et al. 2015). The data are available for crucial time horizons that depict land use in specific, important periods of Czech social and economic development: • 1845: the landscape at the onset of a market economy; • 1896: the culmination of extensive development of agricultural land use, a horizon with an increasing role played by intensification of farming; • 1948: the end of the market economy and onset of a centrally planned economy; • 1990: the end of the centrally planned economy and return to a market economy; • 2000: the first decade of a market economy in Czechia; • 2010: twenty years of a market economy, influenced by admission into the European Union. These data make it possible to survey long time sequences that provide vital information on trends in the development of individual land categories and the total land-use structure in each cadastral unit. In this database, however, it is not possible to capture the changes within a cadastral unit at the parcel level. In order to conduct detailed research inside the cadasters at the level of parcels or ecosystems, we employ geoecological methods, fieldwork (surveys and mapping) in small model areas, and datasets derived from remote sensing data such as the CORINE Land Cover dataset (Corine Land Cover 2018). The results of the evaluation of trends in land-use changes are a starting point for examining the driving forces of these changes and their impact on local and regional development. Similar approaches suitable for analyses of long-term land-use changes and utilizing the land registry data were applied in Slovenia (Gabrovec, Petek and Kladnik 2001; Gabrovec and Petek 2003; Gabrovec and Kumer 2019) and Austria (Haberl, Batterbury and Moran 2001; Krausmann 2001; Haberl et al. 2003). 109 Lucie Kupkova, Ivan Bicik, Zdenek Boudny, Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions 3 Results 3.1 Land-use changes in Czech border regions based on land-registry data Bicik and Stepanek (1994) published one of the first studies focused on land-use changes in the borderland using the LUCC Czechia database. They used three time horizons (between 1845, 1948, and 1990) and eight land-use categories, documenting a significant decrease in the agricultural function in the borderland. The decrease was most significant in western border regions, especially in comparison with interior regions. Bicik and Kabrda (2007) conducted an analysis of the individual sections of the Czech border using the LUCC database. They examined the differences in land-use changes in four time horizons in relation to their distance from the border. They delineated three zones of STUs near the border (the first zone includes STUs touching the border: »at border zone«; the second includes STUs adjoining the first one zone: »intermediate zone«; and the third zone includes STUs adjoining the second zone: »at interior zone«; see Figures 1 and 2). They compared these three zones to each other and with all other STUs in Czechia, or the »interior.« As anticipated, the intensity of change was strongly influenced by differences in elevation, inclination, and soil fertility in individual sets, and also by the ethnic structure of the population. In border zones with a predominantly ethnic Czech population, the total intensity of changes in the landscape was smaller than in the areas primarily or fully inhabited by ethnic Germans, who were expelled after the Second World War. Figures 1 and 2 document changes in arable land and forest areas in the borderland zone compared with the interior. The share of arable land was lower in border regions compared to interior regions. In addition, it decreased significantly in the first »at border« zone, especially between 1948 and 1990. The percentage of forest areas was significantly lower in the interior and experienced little change in the years studied, whereas in the border zones, especially in the »at border« zone, forest areas increased permanently and covered more than 50% of the territory in 1990 and 2000. 3.2 Evaluation of land-use changes in Czech borderland using remote sensing data Najman (2008) analyzed land-cover changes using Corine land cover data for 1990 and 2000 along the whole of the former Iron Curtain in Czechia. Analyzing land-cover changes in the area straddling the border between those years, he delineated a belt with a width of about 15 km along both sides of the Czech border with Germany and Austria. Kupkova, Bicik, and Najman (2013) extended the dataset by using the 2006 Corine Land Cover data. Changes in land cover in two periods (1990-2000 and 2000-2006) were evaluated. The results (Table 1) documented a considerably lower intensity of the transformation of the landscape on the Austrian side of the border (west) in comparison with larger changes that occurred on the Czech side (east) in both periods under observation. This result reflects the fact that land use has not been influenced by the border on the Austrian side, whereas the situation was different on the Czech side. Only state farms (not agricultural cooperatives or private farmers) could farm in the proximity of the Iron Curtain. They had specially trained employees, many of whom were members of the auxiliary corps of the border guard. For this reason, farming intensity was substantially lower on the Czech side of the Iron Curtain, where the land previously designated for agriculture was abandoned, often giving way to new wilderness (Lipsky 1995, 2010). The results confirm a varying representation of individual land-cover categories in 1990 in the area to the east and west of the Iron Curtain, and their differing changes between 1990 and 2006. Before 1990, the centrally planned economy and subsidy system pressured farms to use the land to the east of the Iron Curtain for agriculture, even under unfavorable conditions. To the west, the market economy made intensive agriculture untenable under unfavorable conditions, even when high subsidies were provided. The land cover was very diverse, and the land use respected more natural conditions. The analysis also confirmed a varying intensity of changes in the individual border sections examined and more intensive land-cover changes to the east of the Iron Curtain after 1990. Between 1990 and 2000, changes occurred on 3.96% of the area under study to the east of the Iron Curtain; in the west similar changes only occurred on 0.52% of the area studied. From 2000 to 2006, changes occurred on 0.61% of the area on the east side and on 0.16% of the area on the west side. The biggest changes were recorded in Czech border sections, which saw relatively large-scale agricultural extensification and reforestation. The changes occurred in over 8% of the area from 1990 to 2000. This contrasts with the border section in Austria, which was very stable throughout the period under observation (changes in both periods only occurred on 0.13% of the Austrian region). 110 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1845 1948 1990 2000 ■ 0-interior ■ C-at interior ■ B-intermediate ■ A-at border Figure 1: Percentage of arable land in various Czech border zones (Bicik and Kabrda 2007). 60 50 1845 1948 1990 2000 ■ 0-interior ■ C-at interior ■ B-intermediate ■ A-at border Figure 2: Percentage of forest areas in various Czech border zones (Bicik and Kabrda 2007). 111 Lucie Kupkova, Ivan Bicik, Zdenek Boudny, Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions The results are presented in Figure 3, capturing the extent of the changes in mapping units larger than 25 hectares. There is substantially higher transformation on the Czech side, especially in the first period after the fall of the Iron Curtain. Table 1: Land cover in the Czech-Austrian borderland in 1990 and land-cover changes for 1990-2000 and 2000-2006 (15 km along both sides of the border; east = 15 km border section in Czechia; west = 15 km border section in Austria; Kupkova, Bicik and Najman 2013). Category Share of category Decrease/increase Decrease/increase 1990 (% i>) in area of category, in area of category, 1990-20 )00 (%) 1990-20 06 (%) East West East West East West Urban fabric 2.65 3.28 0.90 0.42 1.33 0.61 Industrial, commercial, and transport units 0.36 0.01 3.11 0.00 3.75 9.51 Mine, dump, and construction sites 0.13 0.00 -39.52 0.00 -20.98 + Artificial, non-agricultural vegetated areas 0.14 0.00 0.00 + 21.79 + Arable land 43.06 31.96 -12.87 -0.01 -15.97 -0.06 Permanent crops 1.47 3.10 5.04 -0.06 36.06 -0.27 Pastures 4.18 3.47 127.43 -0.77 146.03 -1.15 Heterogeneous agricultural areas 6.88 25.16 1.98 -0.08 1.93 -0.20 Forests 34.41 32.86 5.83 -0.20 5.74 -0.36 Scrub and/or herbaceous vegetation 0.40 0.01 -2.60 69.67 -1.62 39.70 Transitional woodland/shrubs 2.85 0.04 -69.56 127.55 -67.63 217.82 Inland wetlands 0.48 0.05 3.17 0.00 2.19 0.00 Inland waters 2.98 0.05 -0.35 0.00 0.01 0.00 Note: The sign + means that the initial area in 1990 was 0 and the share of the category increased during the period (the share of the total area in the second year was lower than 0.1% of the total area). Figure 3: Land-cover changes between 1990 and 2000 (left), and 2000 and 2006 (right; adapted from Kupkova, Bicik and Najman 2013). 112 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 3.3 A case study of Chvalec and Petrikovice: a combination of land-registry data and a field survey The area studied is in northeastern Bohemia in the Krkonose foothills. The selection of this area was due to its position in the Czech-Polish borderland, which had not yet been analyzed for land-use / land-cover development. Both the LUCC Czechia (2018) database and field survey (in 2015) were used to analyze this area. The data showed (Table 2) that the major changes in the Chvalec region occurred after the Second World War and in the last thirty years, when its function changed from agricultural to recreational. Table 2 shows the differentiation of land use in six time horizons, with a visible trend of decreasing size in arable and agricultural land and an increase of forest from one-third to half. Similar processes were observed in Slovenian borderlands close to the Croatian border (Ribeiro, Burnet and Torkar 2013). The political and economic driving forces between 1845 and 1948 and the forced nationalization of local agriculture influenced changes in landscape functions after 1945 without the installation of the Iron Curtain there. The expulsion of ethnic Germans and the decline of coalmining in the vicinity (in the 1960s) were important factors responsible for transforming the landscape into an economic and settlement periphery (Boudny 2018). Figures 4 and 5 show the conversion of arable land into permanent grassland and forest areas from 1845 to 2015. These changes primarily occurred after the Second World War as a result of the expulsion of the ethnic Germans, and again after 1990 due to the abandonment of agricultural land under less favorable conditions for agriculture and its subsequent grassing over. 4 Discussion and conclusions This selection of landscape change in the Czech borderland has demonstrated a clear result. Although they are variously delineated, the regions were influenced by a number of similar driving forces after 1990. Nevertheless, it is striking that the crucial driving forces were the political changes that occurred after the Second World War, as well as between 1989 and 1990. The landscape changes in Czechia were greater than those detected on the other side of the western border between 1990 and 2012 (Najman 2008; Kupkova, Bicik and Najman 2013; Rasin and Chromy 2010). Table 2: Overview of land use development in Chvalec through six time horizons (Boudny 2018). Category 1845 1896 1948 1990 2000 2010 ha % ha % ha % ha % ha % ha % Arable land 833.8 48.6 885.0 51.6 834.3 48.7 363.2 21.09 358.5 20.8 358.1 20.8 Permanent cultures 3.1 0.18 2.9 0.17 7.2 0.42 26.1 1.52 23.7 1.38 23.4 1.36 Permanent grasslands 224.5 13.1 234.0 13.65 219.3 12.8 295.0 17.1 306.0 17.8 303.2 17.6 Agricultural land 1061.4 61.9 1121.9 65.5 1060.8 61.9 684.3 39.74 688.2 39.9 684.7 39.8 Forest areas 591.3 34.4 559.0 32.6 599.9 35.0 881.6 51.2 882.1 51.2 893.0 51.9 Water bodies 3.5 0.2 - - 3.5 0.2 5.9 0.3 5.9 0.3 6.6 0.38 Built-up areas 5.3 0.3 - - 12.6 0.7 13.7 0,8 13.8 0.8 13.3 0.8 Other areas 54.0 3.2 - - 36.3 2.12 136.4 7.9 132.0 7.7 124.6 7.2 Remaining areas 62.8 3.7 33.1 1.93 52.4 3.1 156.0 9.1 151.7 8.8 144.5 8.4 Figure 4: Land use in Chvalec and Petrikovice near Trutnov in 1845 (Boudny 2018). p p. 114 Figure 5: Land use in Chvalec and Petrikovice in 2015 (Boudny 2018). p p. 115 113 C3 Arable land ^^ Permanent cultures (^3 Permanent grassland Forest areas Water bodies Built-up areas (^3 Remaining areas C3 Arable land ^^ Permanent cultures (^3 Permanent grassland (^3 Forest areas (^3 Water bodies (3^3 Built-up areas (33 Remaining areas Lucie Kupkova, Ivan Bicik, Zdenek Boudny, Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions The second basic finding highlights a dramatic loss of arable land on the periphery and strong depopulation. The natural conditions that weaken or prevent economic activity in such localities are magnified by the significant shortage of manpower in the present day, primarily in manufacturing and services. Czechs and Slovaks from Czechoslovakia's interior, as well as people repatriated from abroad after 1945, often resettled the foothills and mountain areas and lacked the necessary experience for farming in this difficult terrain (Capka, Slezák and Vaculík 2005; Vaishar 1992). Then, after the 1949 establishment of the Iron Curtain, many of them were forced to move further into the interior of the country. This resulted in a significant loss of agricultural land in these areas. Between 1948 and 1963, approximately 15% of agricultural land was lost (Bicík et al. 2010). Hampl and Müller (2011) warned of the differing timing and also the duration of individual social processes. According to Hampl and Müller (2011), as a rule, political processes take place in days or weeks after a situation changes. Economic processes may last months or years, and demographic and social processes last several years. Complex geographical processes that include landscape changes start last and evolve over a longer period of time. This has been confirmed twice in the Czech lands. After the Second World War, the communist coup lasted a few weeks but transformed the political system for forty-two years. The second change followed in 1989, when the Velvet Revolution implemented a fundamental political change within a month, reintroducing Czechoslovakia to the western market economy (Bicík et al. 2015). An examination of the landscape transformation shows that these abrupt political changes initiated a perceptible impact on the entire Czech landscape. These changes took nearly fifteen years to realize, and their duration is substantially longer than their political triggers. These results further prove the higher intensity of land-use changes in border areas compared to the intensity of landscape changes in core areas of the Czech lands and the countryside. In fact, most semi-peripheral areas and a large part of peripheral areas did not experience any major landscape changes after 1948. The future development of border areas will be influenced by many drivers, especially by the EU and national subsidy programs, nature preservation, creation of new job opportunities, and so on; however, the land-use / land-cover changes will most likely be less intensive than in the majority of other Czech regions because border regions are usually marginal when there is no political change. ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS: This article was supported by project GA CR GBP410/12/G113 »Historical Geography Research Centre« (Faculty of Science, Charles University in Prague and The Institute of History, Academy of Sciences of the Czech Republic, v. v. i.). 5 References Bicík, I., Jelecek, L., Kabrda, J., Kupková, L., Lipsky, Z., Mares, P., Sefrna, L., Stych, P., Winklerová, J. 2010: Vyvoj vyuzití ploch v Cesku. Praha. Bicík, I., Kabrda, J. 2007: Land-use changes in Czech border regions (1845-2000). Acta Universitatis Carolinae, Geographica 42-12. Bicík, I., Kupková, L., Jelecek, L., Kabrda, J., Stych, P, Janousek, Z., Winklerová, J. 2015: Land use changes in the Czech Republic 1845-2010. Cham. Bicík, I., Stepánek, V. 1994: Long-term and current tendencies in land use: case study of the Prague's environs and the Czech Sudetenland. Acta Universitatis Carolinae, Geographica 29-1. Boudny, Z. 2018: Zmeny funkcí a vyuzití ploch v modelovych územích Ceska. Diploma thesis, Department of Social Geography and Regional Development of the Charles University. Prague. Corine Land Cover 2018. Internet: https://land.copernicus.eu/pan-european/corine-land-cover (1.6.2018 Capka, F., Slezák, L., Vaculík, J. 2005: Nové osídlení pohranicí ceskych zemí po druhé svetové válce. Brno. Gabrovec, M., Kumer, P. 2019: Land-use changes in Slovenia from the Franciscean Cadaster until today. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.4892 Gabrovec, M., Petek, F., Kladnik, D. 2001: Land-use changes in the 20th century in Slovenia. Land use/cover changes in selected regions in the world 1. Asahikawa. Gabrovec, M., Petek, F. 2003: Changes in Land Use in the Border Zone of Slovenia and Austria - the Case of the Svecinske Gorice Hills. Dealing with diversity, 2nd International Conference of the European Society for Environmental History, Proceedings. Prague. 116 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Haberl, H., Batterbury, S., Moran, E. 2001: Using and shaping the land: a long-term perspective. Land Use Policy 18-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/s0264-8377(00)00040-5 Haberl, H., Erb, K. H., Krausmann, F., Adensam, H., Schulz, B. N. 2003: Land-use change and socio-economic metabolism in Austria, Part II: land-use scenarios for 2020. Land Use Policy 20-1. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/s0264-8377(02)00049-2 Hampl, M., Müller, J. 2011: Spolecenska transformace a regionalni diferenciace Ceska: priklad vyvoje rozmisteni pracovnich mist a obyvatelstva. Geografie 116-3. Jelecek, L. 2006: Cadastre. Our Earth's Changing Land, An Encyclopedia of Land-Use and Land-Cover Change, Volume 1. Westport. Krausmann, F. 2001: Land use and industrial modernization: an empirical analysis of human influence on the functioning of ecosystems in Austria 1830-1995. Land Use Policy 18-1. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1016/s0264-8377(00)00042-9 Kucera, Z., Kucerova, S. 2012: Historical geography of persistence, destruction, and creation: the case of rural landscape transformations in Czechia's resettled borderland. Historicka Geografie 38-1. Kupkova, L., Bicik, I., Najman, J. 2013: Land cover changes along the Iron Curtain 1990-2006. Geografie 118-2. Lipsky, Z. 1995: The changing face of the Czech rural landscape. Landscape and Urban Planning 31, 1-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/0169-2046(94)01034-6 Lipsky, Z. 2010: Present changes in European rural landscapes. Landscape modelling. Dordrecht. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/978-90-481-3052-8_2 LUCC Czechia 2018: Vyzkumne centrum zmen vyuziti ploch Ceska. Internet: https://web.natur.cuni.cz/ ksgrrsek/lucc/index.php/data/ (1.6.2018). Mares, P., Rasin, R., Pipan, P. 2013: Abandoned Landscapes of Former German Settlement in the Czech Republic and in Slovenia. Cultural Severance and the Environment, Environmental History 2. Dordrecht. Najman, J. 2008: Hodnoceni vlivu zelezne opony na zmeny krajiny s vyuzitim dat CORINE Land Cover. Diploma thesis, Department of Social Geography and Regional Development of Charles University. Prague. Rasin, R., Chromy, P. 2010: Land use and land cover development along the Czech-Austrian boundary. Land Use/Cover Changes in Selected Regions in the World 5. Prague. Ribeiro, D., Burnet, J. E., Torkar, G. 2013: Four windows on borderlands : dimensions of place defined by land cover change data from historical maps. Acta geographica Slovenica 53-2. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.3986/AGS53204 Stepanek, V. 1992: The Iron Curtain and its impact on the environment in the Czech Republic. Acta Universitatis Carolinae, Geographica 27-1. Vaishar, A. 1992: Ethnic, religious and social problems of frontier districts in the Czech Republic. Geographica Slovenica 24. 117 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019, 119-141 LAND-USE CHANGES IN SLOVENIAN TERRACED LANDSCAPES Drago Kladnik, Matjaž Geršič, Primož Pipan, Manca Volk Bahun Overgrowth of former winegrowing terraces in the Haloze Hills. Drago Kladnik, Matjaž Geršič, Primož Pipan, Manca Volk Bahun, Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.6988 UDK: 911.53:631.613(497.4) 631.613:711.14(497.4) COBISS: 1.01 Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes ABSTRACT: This article presents the findings of a study on long-term land-use changes in eight areas of various Slovenian landscapes. The emphasis is on comparing changes on terraced and non-terraced land from the early nineteenth century to the present and on a typological classification of land-use change, whereby a fifth type (i.e., extensification) is added to the established four types in Slovenia: afforestation, grass overgrowth, intensification, and urbanization. The article explains which factors have a decisive impact on land-use changes, especially in terms of abandoning terrace cultivation. The methodology used proves that there are important differences in the rate of land-use change between terraced and non-terraced land. KEY WORDS: geography, terraces, terraced landscape, land use, land-use changes, land-use change typology, Slovenia Spremembe rabe zemljišč v slovenskih terasiranih pokrajinah POVZETEK: V članku predstavljamo rezultate raziskave dolgoročnega spreminjanja rabe zemljišč na osmih območjih v različnih slovenskih pokrajinah. Poudarek je na primerjavi sprememb na terasiranih in neterasiranih zemljiščih od začetka 19. stoletja do sodobnosti ter tipološki klasifikaciji spreminjanja zemljiške rabe, kjer smo v Sloveniji ustaljenim štirim tipom (ogozdovanje, ozelenjevanje, intenzifikacija, urbanizacija) dodali petega, ekstenzifikacijo. Ob tem pojasnjujemo, kateri dejavniki odločilno vplivajo na spreminjanje rabe zemljišč, še posebej z vidika opuščanja obdelave teras. Z uporabljeno metodologijo smo dokazali, da obstajajo pomembne razlike med stopnjo spreminjanja zemljiške rabe na terasiranih in neterasiranih zemljiščih. KLJUČNE BESEDE: geografija, terase, terasirana pokrajina, raba zemljišč, spreminjanje rabe zemljišč, tipologija spreminjanja rabe zemljišč, Slovenija The paper was submitted for publication on July 20th, 2018. Uredništvo je prejelo prispevek 20. julija 2018. Drago Kladnik, Matjaž Geršič, Primož Pipan, Manca Volk Bahun Research Center of the Slovenian Academy of Sciences and Arts, Anton Melik Geographical Institute drago.kladnik@zrc-sazu.si, matjaz.gersic@zrc-sazu.si, primoz.pipan@zrc-sazu.si, manca.volk@zrc-sazu.si 120 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 1 Introduction Cultivated terraces, which constitute terraced landscapes, are among the most evident human signatures on the landscape (Honghe Declaration 2010; Scaramellini and Varotto 2008; Kladnik 2017). They are a result of transformation of the natural environment by societies to overcome their physical limitations (topography, climate, and soil) and obtain necessary resources for their survival (Romero Martín, Gonzáles Morales and Ramón Ojeda 2016). Traditional agricultural terraces were created with manual cultivation in mind. Because many are not adapted to modern mechanized agriculture, they are being abandoned (Ažman Momirski and Kladnik 2009). Abandoning the cultivation of terraces is also the result of rural flight and social restratification connected with the decreasing importance of agriculture and the strengthening of other economic activities (Arnáez et al. 2011; García-Ruiz and Lana-Renault 2011; Stanchi et al. 2012; Lasanta et al. 2013). Terraces are also disappearing due to ownership changes and consequent differences in vineyard planting patterns (Pipan and Kokalj 2017). In addition, land use on terraces is changing, with pronounced overgrowth (Žiberna 2015). The best-known protected terraced landscapes worldwide are mentioned in studies by Tarolli, Preti and Romano (2014), Peters (2015), Varotto (2015), and Kladnik, Šmid Hribar and Geršič (2017). In Slovenia, the first detailed study of agricultural terraces and terraced landscapes was conducted by Titl (1965) and Moritsch (1969) followed by Ažman Momirski et al. (2008) significantly later. Terraced landscapes have also been explored by Ažman Momirski and Kladnik (2009; 2015), Križaj Smrdel (2010), Ažman Momirski and Gabrovec (2014), Ažman Momirski and Berčič (2016), Geršič (2016), and Kladnik et al. (2016). In 2017, a special issue of the journal Acta geographica Slovenica (57-2) was published, titled Terraced Landscapes (Kladnik, Kruse and Komac 2017), and a volume on terraced landscapes was published in Slovenian (Kladnik 2016) and English (Kladnik 2017) to commemorate the seventieth anniversary of the ZRC SAZU Anton Melik Geographical Institute. The authors of this article are not familiar with any Slovenian or international study that compares changes on terraced and non-terraced land or that provides a typological classification of land-use change. Petek (2007) did provide an exhaustive study of land-use change in the northern Gorica Hills (Sln. Goriška brda), but he did not pay any special attention to agricultural terraces. Similarly, the study of the terraced landscape of the Gorica Hills (Ažman Momirski et al. 2008) extends no further than a comparison of land use at the time of the survey conducted under Emperor Francis I of Austria and during the early twenty-first century. The Mediterranean and the Alps are most extensively covered in studies of land use in European terraced landscapes. These types of studies are limited to individual regions or smaller pilot areas. For example, in the Mediterranean, Grimalt Gelabert, Blazquez Salom and Rodriguez Gomila (1992) explored land use on the terraces of the northwestern part of Mallorca, Dunjó, Pardini and Gispert (2003) examined land-use change effects on abandoned terraced soils in the Mediterranean catchment of Serra de Rodes in northeast Spain, and Kosmas, Gerontidis and Marathianou (2000) explored the same on the Greek island of Lesbos. Agnoletti et al. (2011) studied rural development in traditional terraced landscapes of northern, central, and southern Italy, Agnoletti et al. (2015) conducted a territorial analysis in Tuscany (Italy), Modica, Pratico and Di Fazio (2017) explored the abandonment of traditional terraced landscape in Calabria (Italy), and Andlar, Šrajer, and Trojanovic (2017) provided a typology of terraced landscapes along the Adriatic coast in Croatia. With regard to the Alps, two extensive publications covering this area were published a decade ago (Fontanari and Patassini 2008; Scaramellini and Varorro 2008), also featuring articles on land use. Outside the Mediterranean and the Alps, these types of studies have also been conducted in Hungary (Kiss et al. 2005) and Slovakia ^pulerová et al. 2017). Relative to landscape diversity, only a few countries, even much larger ones, can be compared to Slovenia (Ciglič and Perko 2013; Perko and Ciglič 2015), where the Alps, the Dinaric Mountains, the Pannonian Basin, and the Mediterranean meet and intertwine, as do Slavic, Germanic, Romance, and Hungarian cultural influences (Kladnik, Perko and Urbanc 2009; Ciglič and Perko 2012). For this reason, Slovenia is renowned for its great geographical variety, which is reflected in its natural and cultural diversity, and many transitional areas. It is also reflected in different types of terraces and terraced landscapes (Kladnik 2016; 2017). Land use and its changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes have been dealt with in detail by Ažman Momirski and Gabrovec (2014), using the cases of Krkavče and Ostrožno Brdo in southwest Slovenia, and as part of studying other aspects this topic has also been highlighted by Kladnik et al. (2016) and Šmid 121 Drago Kladnik, Matjaž Geršič, Primož Pipan, Manca Volk Bahun, Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes Hribar et al. (2017). Using selected areas of southwest Slovenia, Gersic (2016) established that by studying microtoponyms on terraces it is also possible to determine past land use, and Azman Momirski (2017) explored the reliability of land-use data on terraced landscapes in Slovenia. The possibility of identifying abandoned terraces using aerial photos was already reported decades ago by Denevan (1988), and identifying terraces with Lidar was discussed by Bercic (2016). The main research hypothesis of this article is that land-use changes are influenced by whether the land in question is terraced or non-terraced. In addition, the article also explores the changes in land use since the early nineteenth century and the factors that have had a decisive impact on that. The analyses conducted in the pilot areas make it possible to interpret processes at the level of the entire country. 2 Study areas and methods Eight pilot sites were selected (Figure 1) within eight of the nine landscape types according to Perko's natural classification of Slovenia (Perko 1998a; 1998b; 2007; Perko, Hrvatin and Ciglic 2015). The pilot sites have an above-average share of terraced land in comparison to the proportion of terraces in individual landscape types. These types of areas made it easier to identify the processes and dynamics of land-use change. The selection was also based on the morphometric characteristics of the terraces (inclination, aspect, and elevation). No pilot site was selected in the Pannonian plains landscape type (Kladnik et al. 2016). The cartographic representation of land use in the nineteenth century was determined using the Franciscean cadaster, which was carried out under Austrian Emperor Francis I in the 1820s (Golec 2010, 366). The 1:2,880 maps of the Franciscean cadaster for the cadastral municipalities with seven of the eight pilot sites are accessible at the Archives of the Republic of Slovenia in Ljubljana, and the maps for Krkavce are kept at the State Archives in Trieste, Italy. Even though the Franciscean cadaster uses a series of land categories that are no longer included in the modern cadaster, they were combined into the following seven basic land categories based on an established key (Petek 2005, 24-26; Azman Momirski et al. 2008, 73): fields, vineyards, orchards, olive groves, meadows and pastures, forests, and built-up areas. A similar categorization was also provided by Kumer and Gabrovec (2019). Land-use digitization was performed manually. For contemporary cartographic representation of land use, we used Land Use data base for 2018 (Evidenca dejanske rabe ...2018). The following ten land categories were identified in the pilot areas: fields, vineyards, orchards, olive groves, grassland (meadows and pastures), uncultivated agricultural land, farmland being overgrown, forests, built-up areas, and other. First, we ascribed numerical values to the vector data based on the past and present land use. Then we converted both layers to a 1 x1m raster grid. We added up the two raster layers produced this way, obtaining information for each square meter on whether land use has changed there since the early nineteenth century (and, if it has, how). A total of eighty-one different values were identified across all the pilot areas. We then vectorized the two summed-up raster layers. In the end, the present-day terraced and non-terraced areas were delimited, which made it possible to compare them. To determine the exact contemporary location of terraces, we employed color digital ortophoto maps, with an image resolution of 0.50 m, fieldwork, and data obtained from aerial laser scanning (Light Detection and Ranging, or lidar), which makes it possible to identify overgrown terraces. The visualization, which was the basis for interpretation, was a combination of techniques suggested by Kokalj, Zaksek and Ostir (2011). We used the present-day state as the starting point for comparing land use in terraced and non-terraced areas, even though we are aware of the disadvantages of this approach. Unfortunately, there are no accurate cartographic sources available to provide detailed information on the extent of terraces in the past. The cartographic material in the cadaster does not show terraces, but they are mentioned in certain protocols or the text section of the cadaster, such as with the Piran cadastral municipality (Catasto franceschino, Elaborati 1819-1819). From the maps of the Franciscean cadaster we could only indirectly speculate about their extent Figure 1: Eight pilot sites selected. p p. 123 Figure 2: Land-use changes from the time of the Franciscean cadaster to 2018 in the Krkavce pilot area. p p. 124 Figure 3: Typology of land-use change from the time of the Franciscean cadaster to 2018 in the Krkavce pilot area. p p. 125 122 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 123 Drago Kladnik, Matjaž Geršič, Primož Pipan, Manca Volk Bahun, Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes Curent land use a a •ill m m ¿i â Built-up areas " Forests § Farmland being overgrown Meadows and pastures § Olive groves a Orchards .S Vineyards S Fields -o 5 -S 3 s a ' S S £ Š? I 1 H 3 !s § I O y C Sf Ë 9 3 f u 51 Number of all Patches Nz Nz >1 Index of the Relative Rrn _ m Number of Land Uses "w 0 < RPR < 1 m = number of different land uses Nz =number of all patches. mmax =maximum number of possible land uses. mm>.=25 mmax PR =25 Land-use proportion distribution Land-use proportion index Rt V 0 < J m S' O < IDrt < 1 1IDr, = 1 R(=area of a single land use; this is the sum of areas of all patches of land use r. A0=area of the site. The sum of proportions of all land uses in a site is 1. If a single land use exists, the index value is 1. The value of 0 is unattainable. Characteristics of patches of a single land use Index of shape and size _ of patches 'kom 1 0 < WV2 < 1 This describes the shape and size of a patch 'iom = ipr. A = area and P=perimeter L was obtained with linear standardization of ve/ patch areas using the following equation: l'vek = 0.05 ha -> /«, = 0 0.05 ha < /;„, < 4ha -> = 'vekj Land use ratios Simpson's diversity index SIDI = 1-^iM? i=i 0 < SIDI < 1 Ad( = proportional part of land use in the study area, where there are m different land uses. m y Ad,=i SIDI = 0, when there is a single land use, approaching 1 by increasing the number and evenness of distribution of land-use proportions. The land divisions were based on geographical dividing lines (to a stream, road, forest, or village) or the cadastral municipality boundary. We selected a contiguous area of land showing the characteristics of arable land division (Ilešič 1950; Foški 2017). For Zatolmin and Predoslje, all of the agricultural land is considered within a cadastral municipality. For Kleče and Podgora, the agricultural land between Podgora and Kleče that is still divided into strips is considered; furthermore, nine contact enclosures within the cadastral municipality of Pernice are considered. In Vinjole we address the geographically coherent areas of a hamlet based on geographical divisions (i.e., stream, ridge, forest, or road). The sites were named after the closest settlement or hamlet. The analysis of land use in 2015 was carried out using data from the Land Use data base (Evidenca dejanske rabe ... 2015). Using graphic cross-sections, the Land Use data base data were trimmed to the area of the sites. All patches smaller than 20 m2, which are a consequence of the graphic cross-section of the Land Use data base with the area of a site and which are at the edges of an area, were aggregated with contiguous land use. For all selected sites we obtained cadastral maps of the Franciscean Cadaster from the Archives of the Republic of Slovenia (Franciscejski kataster za Kranjsko 1825; 1826; Franciscejski kataster za Primorsko 1822; Franciscejski kataster za Štajersko 1825) or the State Archives in Trieste (Catasto franceschino 1818) and georeferenced them using affine transformation in ArcGIS 10.3 based on the tie points from the land Figure 1: Distribution of test sites by various landscape types of Slovenia. p p. 166 165 Mojca Foski, Alma Zavodnik Lamovsek, Monitoring land-use change using selected indices 166 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 cadaster depiction (Zemljiški kataster 2015). Vectorization was carried out and the data were topologi-cally sorted. Based on the records and the associated key of the Franciscean Cadaster (Franciscejski kataster za Štajersko 1823-1869; Čuček 1979; Čuček-Kumelj 1983), the land use at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced was classified into twenty-five classes: field, vegetable garden, fruit garden, hop plantation, field with fruit trees, field with olive trees (olive grove), vineyard, vineyard with olive trees, dry meadow, wet meadow, meadow with scrubland, meadow with fruit trees, pasture, pasture with trees, wetland, wetland with rushes, deciduous forest, coniferous forests, mixed forest, grove, shrubs, built-up land (occupied by structures and tracks), water, quarry, clay pit or rock and other. Some categories, such as saffron, chestnut plantations, paddy fields, and so on, were not included in the total sum of land uses because we assumed that they are not found in Slovenian territory. Altogether, the Land Use data base contains twenty-five land uses (Interpretacijski ključ 6.2.2014). The analysis (calculations of indices and graphic representations) was performed in ArcGIS 10.3 (Esri); Microsoft Excel 2010 and IBM SPSS 23 software were used for calculations and statistical processing. 3 Results Figure 2 shows land uses in selected sites for 2015 and for the time when the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced. Table 3 shows the calculated values of indices (PR, Nz, RPR, IDr , SIDI) and the IDr dis- v max ' tribution. The Use Proportion Index (IDr) is shown in the last column of Table 3 as a graph. For each land use its proportion is shown, and the graphic representation shows the relationships between land-use proportions in two time periods. For example, in Pernice there are ten different land uses identified today (PR = 10), but only two land uses stand out in terms of proportion (Table 3, the last column). There were five land uses (PR = 5) there at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced, but they were more evenly distributed (Table 3, last column). Figure 3 shows the case of Vinjole with a graphic depiction of the IOVz and IOVz_FK values, and Figure 4 shows the distribution of values IOVz and IOVz_FK in the histogram with ten equally sized classes. The same methodology was used to analyze all other selected sites; the analysis results are available in Foški (2017, 187-202). The number of various land uses (i.e., richness; Table 3, column 1) increased in all sites, the most at Vinjole (i.e., from three during the establishment of the Franciscean Cadaster to twelve land uses in the Land Use data base). In Vinjole, the number of patches (Nz) increased significantly as well, from eighteen to 464. The number of patches remained almost the same in Predoslje, whereas the prevailing land-use proportion changed (IDr ). Interestingly, during the establishment of the Franciscean Cadaster, fields prevailed (IDrmax FK= 0.93) with much larger areas than those today (IDrmax= 0.49), even though agricultural land consolidation was undertaken in the area. A similar trend of a decreasing proportion of arable land is observed in Kleče and Podgora (IDr FK =0.93; IDr = 0.62). In Zatolmin, meadows with trees ® v max_ max ' prevailed at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced, whereas today meadows prevail (land-use code 1300 from the Land Use data base). In Vinjole, olive groves still prevail, but their proportion decreased substantially (IDrmax FK = 0.97, IDrmax = 0.26); at present, olive groves are identified only when they are the prevailing land use in an area larger than 500 m2 (Interpretacijski ključ 6.2 2014). Forest land prevails in Pernice, whereas pastures with trees prevailed when the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced. Land-use changes can be identified using Simpson's Diversity Index. At Vinjole, Simpson's diversity index changed from 0.07 during the introduction of the Franciscean Cadaster to 0.99 in 2015. An index close to 0 suggests the prevalence of a single land use, as is evident in Figure 2 (Vinjole in 1818), whereas an index value close to 1 suggests an equal distribution of a larger number of land uses, as is evident in Figure 2 (Vinjole in 2015). Importantly, when the Franciscean Cadaster was established, the land use »vineyard with olive trees« was registered for almost all of Vinjole, whereas today mixed uses are no longer in place and the land uses »vineyard« or »olive grove« are registered separately if they cover an area greater than 500 m2 (Interpretacijski ključ 6.2 2014). Land-use diversity inside individual parcels during the establishment of the Franciscean Cadaster was greater, whereas today land-use diversity in the entire study area of Vinjole is greater (PR = 12). The same values of SIDI and SIDI_FK for Predoslje and for Kleče and Podgora Figure 2: Land use in 2015 and at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced. p p. 168-169 167 Mojca Foski, Alma Zavodnik Lamovsek, Monitoring land-use change using selected indices Predoslje 2015 1826 168 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Legend land use 2015 Objects I I Arable land I I Vineyards I I Extensive orchards I I Meadows and pastures I I Olive groves ^H Overgrown areas I I Forest trees on agricultural land I I Riparian overgrowth and forest hedges I I Forest I I Built-up areas and related surfaces I I Waters Legend land use 1818-1826 Objects I I Arable land I I Vegetable garden I I Vineyards I I Vineyard with olive groves I I Dry meadows I I Meadows with orchards I I Pasture/Pasture with trees I I Coniferous forest I Deciduous forest i km Content and map by: Mojca Foški Source: Catasto franceschino 1818; Franciscejski kataster 1822-1826; Evidenca ... 2015 © ULFGG 0 169 Mojca Foski, Alma Zavodnik Lamovsek, Monitoring land-use change using selected indices show a similar trend of changes. A similar value of SIDI (close to 0.55) is found in Zatolmin, Predoslje, Klece and Podgora, and Pernice; two land uses prevail, as illustrated in the graphs (Table 3, last column). The proportion of prevailing land use (IDrmax) at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was established and that of today suggests that prevailing land use has changed. Table 3: Land-use fragmentation for selected sites in 2015 and at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced. Field PR Nz RPR IDr„ LAND USE (IDO SIDI distribution chart IDr Zatolmin 11 190 0.44 0.65 meadows 0.53 J_____ Zatolmin FK 4 128 0.16 0.51 pasture 0.62 Vinjole 12 464 0.48 0.26 olive groves 0.99 Vinjole FK 3 18 0.12 0.97 vineyard with olive groves 0.07 ■ _ _ Predoslje 8 113 0.32 0.49 arable land 0.54 I.I..... Predoslje FK 4 106 0.16 0.93 arable land 0.13 1___ Kleče and Podgora 9 137 0.36 0.62 meadows 0.54 .__!__... Kleče and Podgora FK 4 49 0.16 0.93 arable land 0.13 ■ _ _ Pernice 10 271 0.4 0.63 forest 0.51 _ ... 1. Pernice FK 5 124 0.2 0.36 pasture with trees 0.71 . .11 Legend H 0.0-0.1 □ 0.2-0.3 □ 0.4-0.5 H 0.6-0.7 H 0.8-0.9 H 0.1-0.2 □ 0.3-0.4 □ 0.5-0.6 H 0.7-0.8 H 0.9-1.0 Content and map by: Mojca Foški Source: Catasto franceschino; Evidenca ... 2015 © ULFGG Figure 3: Index of Shape and Size of Patches (lOVz) for Vinjole. 170 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 The changes in indices are also evident in visual depictions of land use in two time cross-sections (Figure 2). As a rule, the graphic representation fails to show the entire extent of land-use diversity because the proportions of land uses are rather small. The changes in prevailing land uses (Table 3, IDrmax, graph) and the distribution of land uses in a site are clearly evident (Table 3, SIDI, graph). 2015 200 180 160 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0 IOVz 0.0-0.1 0.2-0.3 0.4-0.5 0.6-0.7 0.8-0.9 Number of patches 111 188 158 6 1 0 0 0 0 0 Share of patches [%] 13.11 42.71 33.11 5.47 5.59 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 1818 12 IOVz 0.0-0.1 0.2-0.3 0.4-0.5 0.6-0.7 0.8-0.9 Number of patches 1 3 10 1 1 0 0 2 0 0 Share of patches [%] 0.01 0.30 5.09 2.62 2.71 0.00 0.00 89.27 0.00 0.00 Figure 4: Distribution of values lOVz for Vinjole. 171 Mojca Foski, Alma Zavodnik Lamovsek, Monitoring land-use change using selected indices The Index of Shape and Size of Patches (IOVz) shows the relationship between small and large patches. The index is calculated for each patch separately, whereas the situation for the area of a site (all patches) is best illustrated using a histogram in ten equal classes (Figure 4, the case of Vinjole). The large number of patches in lower classes (0.0-0.1; 0.1-0.2; 0.2-0.3) suggests large land-use fragmentation, particularly if the proportion of the land use in question in the site is large. The histogram for the case of Vinj ole (Figure 4) shows that many patches are in the first three classes, which together make up 88.93% of the study area, whereas a detailed land-use structure is also visible in Figure 2 (the case of Vinjole). The large number of patches in higher classes (0.7-0.8; 0.8-0.9; 0.9-1.0) suggests large contiguous areas of land use, particularly when the proportion of these land uses is large. The two patches in the 0.7-0.8 class shown on the histogram (Figure 4) correspond to a full 89.27% of the area, and land-use contiguity is also evident in Figure 2 (the case of Vinjole). Because of mixed land use at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced, in the area there was an even mix of vineyards and olive trees, whereas today the large number of patches in the area (Nz = 464) and their land-use diversity suggest a much higher landscape diversity of the area. The working methodology for capturing land use in the Land Use data base should be emphasized, where the number of polygons increases with each new revision of data, despite the fact that the spatial situation has not changed (Foski 2018). 4 Discussion Generally, a single index can describe one land-use characteristic; the illustration of various land-use characteristics requires a larger set of indices, for which it is important that they be independent and that their number not be too large. The selection of indices for describing land use in a site was recognized as being sufficient. Because there were a maximum of twenty-five land uses both during the introduction of the Franciscean Cadaster as well as in 2015, the index of the relative number of land uses was found to be less useful. Nevertheless, this correspondence in the number of various land uses is purely accidental. The number of land uses in the Franciscean Cadaster is, in fact, larger, but we only took into account the land uses found in Slovenian territory. Its applicability would increase if the number of land uses in two time cross-sections varied. In any case, the number of different land uses in two time periods does not say anything about the comparability of individual categories. We are also unable to precisely determine the relationship between the individual categories in the past and today due to the various criteria and the purpose of determining land uses. At the time the Franciscean Cadaster was established, a distinction was made between a meadow with scrubland, a meadow with fruit trees, a pasture, and a pasture with trees. Today, on the basis of Interpretation Key (Interpretacijski kljuc 6.2 2014), we register extensive orchards, permanent meadows, and marshy meadows. Pastures with trees prevailed in Pernice at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced, whereas today this category is often divided into permanent grassland and overgrown areas. Even at the level of a meadow one cannot equate the land use at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced with the categories used today. Today the land use in Vinjole (mixed land use at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced) is classified into vineyards and olive groves separately. Some authors (Petek 2005; Verderber 2013; Gabrovec and Kumer 2019) made a comparative table of land uses at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced and in the Land Use data base, respectively, but they combined some of the categories (e.g. field, meadow, forest, and vineyard), which was suitable for the purpose of their work, whereas the information on land-use diversity in various time periods was lost. Due to the incomparability of the categories, the information on land-use richness can be somewhat misleading. This can be avoided if one is familiar with all the characteristics of identifying land use across different time periods. A comparison of data from two time periods is possible if the data used are of equal quality (Wu et al. 2002) - which, however, cannot be said for the data on land use at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced and the Land Use data base in 2015. The minimum mapping unit, working methodology, precision and accuracy of data, and data maintenance vary. We believe that such differences in data fail to impact the key findings and the checking of indices' usefulness, and that the data from the Franciscean Cadaster, particularly with vectorization in place, are highly useful for identifying land-use changes, which is in agreement with the findings by Petek and Urbanc (2005), Harvey, Kaim, and Gajda (2014), Bicik et al. 172 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 (2015), and Gabrovec and Kumer (2019). The time interval (approximately 180 years) is large enough to make the changes obvious so that they are reflected in the indices. The number of land-use types present, or patch richness (PR), increased in all sites compared to the time when the Franciscean Cadaster was introduced. The increased number of patches, the decreased number of large enclosed patches (IOVz), and the decreased prevailing land-use proportion (IDrmax) suggest land-use fragmentation and larger diversity of vegetation cover. This finding contradicts some studies, which suggest a decrease in land-use diversity and particularly an increase in contiguous areas of a single land use, usually forests (Munroe, Croissant and York 2008; Hansen and Adhikari 2018). Such findings are often the result of analyses of raster data (pixel size) and in large territorial areas (data generalization; Wu et al. 2002). By studying land use in small spatial units, using vector data, one can see the changes that can be lost because of the type of data and the scale (Wu 2004). The cases of studying characteristics of land use at the micro level are essential for understanding landscape ecology (Fischer, Hanspach and Hartel 2011) and can contribute to the understanding of global problems. Some authors (Plieninger et al. 2016) also emphasize that researchers all too frequently focus on studying land-use changes rather than land-use stability. In fact, in 30.1% ofthe EU-27 member states' area there is no indication of an increase in fragmentation (Meiner and Pedroli 2017). The large number of land uses is often visually not detected, particularly if the study area is not large or when the land-use structure is very fine. This is why using indices is more appropriate than visual comparisons of land-use maps. The index can be calculated for the data in various time cross-sections, and the interpretation of the values in a time series allows continuous monitoring of the land-use situation and its changes. Therefore indices could be introduced into systematic land-use monitoring in all spatial units. The SIDI index is easy to calculate, and its value is a good indication of land-use distribution and fragmentation. It depends on the prevailing land-use proportion (IDrmax) and the patch richness (PR). Values up to 0.5 show low fragmentation (the case of Predoslje, and Kleče and Podgora at the time the Franciscean Cadaster was established), whereas above 0.7 the land use is fragmented (e.g., Vinjole) because the share of prevailing land use is below 40%. This index is the basic indicator of land-use fragmentation. Based on the available, regularly updated vector land-use data (the Land Use data base), we see great applicability of the SIDI index in systematic monitoring of the situation and land-use changes. 5 Conclusions Land-use changes are among the indicators of social processes, and knowledge of these changes is crucial for many fields of research. This article proposed a method for analyzing and monitoring land-use changes using indices. Using the indices, we pointed out changes that are overlooked at smaller scales and we drew attention to land-use fragmentation and the increasing number of patches. The indices increase the objectivity of research work and facilitate systematic monitoring ofthe land-use situation. Indices have commonly been used for identifying land-use characteristics abroad, and we recommend their use in Slovenia as well. 6 References Alberti, M. 2005: The effects of urban patterns on ecosystem function. International regional science review 28-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1177/0160017605275160 Antrop, M. 2005: Why landscapes of the past are important for the future. Landscape and Urban Planning 70, 1-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/jlandurbplan.2003.10.002 Bičik, I., Jeleček, L., Štepanek, V. 2001: Land-use changes and their social driving forces in Czechia in the 19th and 20th centuries. Land Use Policy 18-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/S0264-8377(00)00047-8 Bičik, I., Kupkova, L., Jeleček, L., Kabrda, J., Štych, P., Janoušek, Z., Winklerova, J. 2015: Land Use Changes in the Czech Republic 1845-2010. Cham, Heidelberg, New York, Dordrecht, London. DOI: https://doi.org/ 10.1007/978-3-319-17671-0_1 Catasto franceschino, Distretto di Pirano, Comune di Pirano, 347. Archivio di Stato di Trieste, Trieste / Državni arhiv v Trstu, Trst. 1818. 173 Mojca Foski, Alma Zavodnik Lamovsek, Monitoring land-use change using selected indices Clark, J. K., McChesney, R., Munroe, D., Irwin, E. G. 2009: Spatial characteristics of exurban settlement pattern in the United States. Landscape and Urban Planning 90, 3-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.landurbplan.2008.11.002 Comer, D., Scott Greene, J. 2015: The development and application of a land use diversity index for Oklahoma City. Applied Geography 60-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.apgeog.2015.02.015 Čuček, I. 1979: Instrukcija za izvršitev deželne izmere za namen splošnega katastra 1824. Inštitut za geodezijo in fotogrametrijo. Ljubljana. Internet: https://www.geovrata.si/geoblog/files/5491d016b6e91e12c5_ Instrukcija_za_izvrsitev_dezelne_izmere_za_namen_splosnega_katastra_1-2.PDF (20.6.2017). Čuček-Kumelj, M. 1983: Uporaba starih topografskih načrtov in kart pri različnih študijah razvoja pokrajine, naselij itd. Raziskovalna naloga. Fakulteta za arhitekturo, gradbeništvo in geodezijo. Ljubljana. Evidenca dejanske rabe kmetijskih in gozdnih zemljišč 2015. Ministrstvo za kmetijstvo, gozdarstvo in prehrano. Ljubljana. Internet: https://rkg.gov.si/ GERK (10.5.2015). Fischer, J., Hanspach, J., Hartel, T. 2011. Continental-scale ecology versus landscape-scale case studies. Frontiers in Ecology and the Environment 9-8. Foški, M. 2017: Določanje parcelnih vzorcev in analiza njihovega spreminjanja v slovenskem podeželskem prostoru. Ph.D. thesis, Univerza v Ljubljani, Fakulteta za gradbeništvo in geodezijo. Ljubljana. Foški, M. 2018: The (non)usefulness of the register of existing agricultural and forest land use for monitoring the processes in urban areas. Acta geographica Slovenica 58-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.1805 Franciscejski kataster za Kranjsko, SI AS 176, k. o. Dol, L147. Arhiv Republike Slovenije. Ljubljana. 1825. Franciscejski kataster za Kranjsko, SI AS 176, k. o. Predoslje, L215. Arhiv Republike Slovenije, Ljubljana. 1826. Franciscejski kataster za Primorsko, SI AS 179, k. o. Zatolmin, G230. Arhiv Republike Slovenije, Ljubljana. 1822. Franciscejski kataster za Štajersko, SI AS 177, k.o. Pernice, M455. Arhiv Republike Slovenije, Ljubljana. 1825. Franciscejski kataster za Štajersko, SI AS 177, Legenda. Arhiv Republike Slovenije, Ljubljana. 1823-1869. Gabrovec, M., Kumer, P. 2019: Land-use changes in Slovenia from the Franciscean Cadaster until today. Acta geographica Slovenica 59-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS4892 Golob, G. 2014: Analiza katastrske rabe v K. O. Šentrupert - od franciscejskega katastra do danes. Diploma thesis. Univerza v Ljubljani, Fakulteta za gradbeništvo in geodezijo. Ljubljana. Hansen, A. J., Adhikari, A. 2018: Land use change and habitat fragmentation of wildland ecosystems of the North Central United States. Landscape and Urban Planning 177-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.landurbplan.2018.04.014 Harvey, F., Kaim, D., Gajda, A. 2014: Analysis ofhistorical change using cadastral materials in the Carpathian foothills. European Journal of Geography 5-3. Internet: https://ruj.uj.edu.pl/xmlui/bitstream/handle/ item/10331/harvey_kaim_gajda_analysis_of_historical_change_using_cadastral_materials.pdf?sequence= 1&isAllowed=y (21. 6.2018). Ilešič, S. 1950: Sistemi poljske razdelitve na Slovenskem. Dela 2. Interpretacijski ključ 6.2. Ministrstvo za kmetijstvo, gozdarstvo in prehrano, Direktorat za kmetijstvo. Ljubljana, 2014. Irwin, E. G., Bockstael, N. E. 2007: The evolution of urban sprawl: Evidence of spatial heterogenity and increasing land fragmentation. Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences of the United States of America 104-52. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1073/pnas.0705527105 Kladnik, D., Petek, F. 2007: Kmetijstvo in spreminjanje rabe tal na Ljubljanskem polju. Geografski vestnik 79-2. Kokalj, Ž., Oštir, K. 2005: Ugotavljanje pokrovnosti iz satelitskih posnetkov in vrednotenje pokrajinskoekoloških tipov Slovenije. Geografski obzornik 52-4. Lo Papa, G., Palermo, V., Dazzi, C. 2011: Is land-use change a cause of loss of pedodiversity? The case of the Mazzarrone study area, Sicily. Geomorphology 135, 3-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.geomorph.2011.02.015 McGarigal, K. 2002: Landscape pattern metrics. Internet: https://www.umass.edu/landeco/pubs/ mcgarigal.2002.pdf (20.12.2015). McGarigal, K. 2015: FRAGSTATS HELP. Amherst. Internet: https://www.umass.edu/landeco/research/ fragstats/documents/fragstats.help.4.2.pdf (20.12.2015). McGarigal, K., Marks, B. J. 1995: FRAGSTATS: Spatial Pattern Analysis Program for Quantifying Landscape Structure. General Technical Report. Washington D. C. DOI: https://doi.org/10.2737/PNW-GTR-351 Meiner, A., Pedroli, B. 2017: Landscapes in transition. An account of 25 years of land cover change in Europe. Luxemburg. Internet: https://www.eea.europa.eu/publications/landscapes-in-transition (1. 6.2018). 174 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Munroe, D. K., Croissant, C., York, A. M. 2005: Land use policy and landscape fragmentation in an urbanizing region: Assessing the impact of zoning. Applied Geography 25-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.apgeog.2005.03.004 Perko, D., Hrvatin, M., Ciglič, R. 2015: Metodologija naravne pokrajinske tipizacije Slovenije. Acta geographica Slovenica 55-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.1938 Petek, F. 2005: Spremembe rabe tal v Slovenskem alpskem svetu. Geografija Slovenije 11. Ljubljana. Petek, F. 2007: Spreminjanje rabe tal v severnih Goriških brdih. Geografski vestnik 79-1. Petek, F., Urbanc, M. 2004: Franciscejski kataster kot ključ za razumevanje kulturne pokrajine v 19. stoletju. Acta geographica Slovenica 44-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS44104 Pijanowski, B. C., Robinson, K. D. 2011: Rates and patterns of land use change in the Upper Great Lakes States, USA: A framework for spatial temporal analysis. Landscape and Urban Planning 102-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016Zj.landurbplan.2011.03.014 Plieninger, T., Draux, H., Fagerholm, N., Bieling, C., Burgi, M., Kizos T., Kuemmerle, T., Primdahl, J., Verburg, P. H. 2016: The driving forces of landscape change in Europe: a systematic review of the evidence. Land Use Policy 57. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.landusepol.2016.04.040 Polenšek, M., Pirnat, J. 2018: Forest patch connectivity: the case of the Kranj-Sora basin, Slovenia. Acta geographica Slovenica 58-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.3001 Ramezani, H., Holm, S. 2011: Sample based estimation of landscape metrics; accuracy of line intersect sampling for estimating edge density and Shannon's diversity index. Environmental Ecology Statistics 18-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/s10651-009-0123-2 Ramezani, H., Holm, S., Allard, A., Stahl, G. 2013: A review of sampling-based approaches for estimating landscape metrics. Norsk Geografisk Tidsskrift - Norwegian Journal of Geography 67-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/00291951.2013.784800 Rempel, R. S., Kaukinen, D., Carr, A. P. 2012: Patch Analyst and Patch Grid. Ontario Ministry of Natural Resources. Centre for Northern Forest Ecosystem Research, Thunder Bay, Ontario. Internet: https://www.cnfer.on.ca/SEP/patchanalyst/Patch5_2_Install.htm (24.5.2018). Ribnikar, P. 1982: Zemljiški kataster kot vir za zgodovino. Zgodovinski časopis 36-4. Ljubljana. Robič, D. 2000: Različno razumevanje in pomen biodiverzitete v ekologiji, posebno v fitocenologiji. Zbornik gozdarstva in lesarstva 63-3. Shoyama, K., Braimoh, A. K. 2011: Analyzing about sixty years of land-cover change and associated landscape fragmentation in Shiretoko Peninsula, Northern Japan. Landscape and Urban Planning 101-1. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.landurbplan.2010.12.016 Shrestha, M. K., York, A. M., Boone, C., Zhang, S. 2012: Land fragmentation due to rapid urbanization in the Phoenix Metropolitan Area: Analyzing the spatiotemporal patterns and drivers. Applied Geography 32-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.apgeog.2011.04.004 Sivrikaya, F., Qakir, G., Kadiogullari, A., Kele§, S., Ba^kent, E., Z., Terzioglu, S. 2007: Evaluating land/use cover changes and fragmentation in the Camili forest planning unit of northeastern Turkey from 1972 to 2005. Land degradation and development 18-4. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1002/ldr.782 Sushant, P., Yuan, F. 2012: Assessing landscape changes and dynamics using patch analysis and GIS modeling. International Journal of Applied Earth Observation and Geoinformation 16. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.jag.2011.12.003 Turner, M. G., Pearson, S. M., Bolstad, P., Wear, D. N. 2003: Effects of land-cover change on spatial pattern of forest communities in the southern Appalachian Mountains (USA). Landscape Ecology 18: Internet: https://link.springer.com/content/pdf/10.1023%2FA%3A1026033116193.pdf (7.1.2016). Verderber, D. 2013: Študija možnosti uporabe arhivskih gradiv franciscejskega katastra za analizo sprememb v prostoru. Diploma thesis, Univerza v Ljubljani, Fakulteta za gradbeništvo in geodezijo. Ljubljana. Wu, J. 2004: Effects of changing scale on landscape pattern analysis: scaling relations. Landscape Ecology 19-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1023/B:LAND. 0000021711.40074.ae Wu, J., Shen, W., Sun, W., Tueller, P. T. 2002: Empirical patterns of the effects of changing scale on landscape metrics. Landscape Ecology 17-8. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1023/A1022995922992 Zemljiški kataster. Geodetska uprava Republike Slovenije. Ljubljana, 2015. Zhang, S., York, A. M., Boone, C. G., Shrestha, M. 2013: Methodological advances in the spatial analysis ofland fragmentation. The Professional Geographer 65-3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1080/00330124.2012.700501 175 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Guidelines for contributing authors in Acta geographica Slovenica EDITORIAL POLICIES 1 Focus and scope The Slovenian geographical journal Acta geographica Slovenica (print version: ISSN: 1581-6613, digital version: ISSN: 1581-8314) is published by the Anton Melik Geographical Institute of the Slovenian Academy of Sciences and Arts Research Center. Acta geographica Slovenica publishes original research papers from all fields of geography and related disciplines, and provides a forum for discussing new aspects of theory, methods, issues, and research findings, especially in central and southeast Europe. We accept original research papers and review papers. Papers presenting new developments and innovative methods in geography are welcome. Submissions should address current research gaps and explore state-of-the-art issues. Research based on case studies should have the added value of transnational comparison and should be integrated into established or new theoretical and conceptual frameworks. The target readership is researchers, policymakers, and university students studying or applying geography at various levels. Submissions are accepted in English or Slovenian. The journal is indexed in the following bibliographic databases: SCIE (Science Citation Index Expanded), Scopus, JCR (Journal Citation Report, Science Edition), ERIH PLUS, GEOBASE Journals, Current Geographical Publications, EBSCOhost, Geoscience e-Journals, Georef, FRANCIS, SJR (SCImago Journal & Country Rank), OCLC WorldCat, and Google Scholar. The journal's publisher is a member of CrossRef. 2 Types of papers Unsolicited or invited original research papers and review papers are accepted. Papers and materials or sections of them should not have been previously published or under consideration for publication elsewhere. The papers should cover subjects of current interest within the journal's scope. 3 Special issues The journal also publishes special issues (thematic supplements). Special issues usually consist of invited papers and present a special topic, with an introduction by the (guest) editors. The introduction briefly presents the topic, summarizes the papers, and provides important implications. 4 Peer-review process All papers are examined by the editor-in-chief. This includes fact-checking the content, spelling and grammar, writing style, and figures. Papers that appear to be plagiarized, are ghost-written, have been published elsewhere, are outside the scope of journal, or are of little interest to readers of Acta geographica Slovenica may be rejected. If the article exceeds the maximum length, the author(s) must correct this before the article is reviewed. The paper is then sent to responsible editors, who check the relevance, significance, originality, clarity, and quality of the paper. If accepted for consideration, the papers are then sent to peer reviewer(s) for double-blind review. Paper are rejected or accepted based on the peer reviews and editorial board's decision. 5 Publication frequency Acta geographica Slovenica is published twice a year. 177 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 6 Open-access policy This journal provides immediate free open access to its content and supports greater global exchange of knowledge by making research freely available. The papers in Acta geographica Slovenica and its predecessors Acta geographica / Geografski zbornik and Geographica Slovenica are available online free of charge. The author(s) receive a free print copy. The journal's publication ethics and publication malpractice statement is available online, as well as information on subscriptions and prices for print copies. AUTHOR GUIDELINES Before submitting a paper, please read the details on the journal's focus and scope, peer-review process, publication frequency, history, and open-access policy. This information is available in the editorial policies. 1 The papers Research papers must be prepared using the journal's template and contain the following elements: - Title: this should be clear, short, and simple. - Information about author(s): submit names (without academic titles), institutions, and e-mail addresses through the online submission system. - Abstract: introduce the topic clearly so that readers can relate it to other work by presenting the background, why the topic was selected, how it was studied, and what was discovered. It should contain one or two sentences about each section (introduction, methods, results, discussion, and conclusions). The maximum length is 800 characters including spaces. - Key words: include up to seven informative key words. Start with the research field and end with the place and country. - Main text: limit the text of the paper to 25,000 characters including spaces and without the reference list, and tables. Do not use footnotes or endnotes. Divide the paper into sections with short, clear titles marked with numbers without final dots: 1 Section title. Use only one level of subsections: 1.1 Subsection title. Research papers should have the following structure: • Introduction: present the background of the research problem (trends and new perspectives), state of the art (current international discussion in the field), research gap, motivation, aim, and research questions. • Methods: describe the study area, equipment, tools, models, programs, data collection, and analysis, define the variables, and justify the methods. • Results: follow the research questions as presented in the introduction and briefly present the results. • Discussion: interpret the results, generalize from them, and present related broader principles and relationships between the study and previous research. Critically assess the methods and their limitations, and discuss important implications of the results. Clarify unexpected results or lacking correlations. • Conclusion: present the main implications of the findings, your interpretations, and unresolved questions, offering a short take-home message. Review papers (narratives, best-practice examples, systematic approaches, etc.) should have the following structure: • Introduction: include 1) the background; 2) the problem: trends, new perspectives, gaps, and conflicts; and 3) the motivation/justification. • Material and methods: provide information such as data sources (e.g., bibliographic databases), search terms and search strategies, selection criteria (inclusion/exclusion of studies), the number of studies screened and included, and statistical methods of meta-analysis. 178 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 • Literature review: use subheadings to indicate the content of the various subsections. Possible structure: methodological approaches, models or theories, extent of support for a given thesis, studies that agree with one another versus studies that disagree, chronological order, and geographical location. • Conclusions: provide implications of the findings and your interpretations (separate from facts), identify unresolved questions, summarize, and draw conclusions. - Acknowledgement: use when relevant. - Reference list: see the guidelines below. 2 Paper submission 2.1 Open journal system Author(s) must submit their contributions through the Acta geographica Slovenica Open Journal System (OJS) using the Word document template. Enter all necessary information into the OJS. Any addition, deletion, or rearrangement of names of the author(s) in the authorship list should be made and confirmed by all coauthors before the manuscript has been accepted, and is only possible if approved by the journal editor. To make anonymous peer review possible, the paper text and figures should not include names of author(s). Do not use contractions or excessive abbreviations. Use plain text, with sparing use of bold and italics. Do not use auto-formatting, such as section or list numbering and bullets. If a text is unsatisfactory, the editorial board may return it to the author(s) for professional copyediting or reject the paper. See the section on the peer-review process for details. Author(s) may suggest reviewers when submitting a paper. 2.2 Language Papers are published in English. Papers are submitted in English or Slovenian and copyedited/translated after acceptance by a professional chosen by the editorial board. The translation or copyediting costs are borne by the author(s) (translation €500, copyediting €200) and must be paid before layout editing. All papers should have English and Slovenian abstracts. 2.3 Supplementary file submission Supplementary files (figures) can be submitted to the OJS packed in one zip file not exceeding 50 MB. 2.4 Submission date The journal publishes the submission date of papers. Please contact the editor with any questions. 3 Citations Examples for citing publications are given below. Using "gray literature" is highly discouraged. 3.1 Citing papers • de Kerk, G. V., Manuel, A. R. 2008: A comprehensive index for a sustainable society: The SSI - the Sustainable Society Index. Ecological Economics 66-2,3. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ecolecon.2008.01.029 • Fridl, J., Urbanc, M., Pipan, P. 2009: The importance of teachers' perception of space in education. Acta geographica Slovenica 49-2. DOI: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS49205 179 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 • Gams, I. 1994a: Types of contact karst. Geografia fisica e dinamica quaternaria 17. • Gams, I. 1994b: Changes of the Triglav glacier in the 1955-94 period in the light of climatic indicators. Geografski zbornik 34. • Perko, D. 1998: The regionalization of Slovenia. Geografski zbornik 38. • van Hall, R. L., Cammeraat, L. H., Keesstra, S. D., Zorn, M. 2016: Impact of secondary vegetation succession on soil quality in a humid Mediterranean landscape. Catena, In press. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.catena.2016.05.021 (25.11.2016). 3.2 Citing books • Cohen, J. 1988: Statistical power analysis for the behavioral sciences. New York. • Fridl, J., Kladnik, D., Perko, D., Orožen Adamič, M. (eds.) 1998: Geografski atlas Slovenije. Ljubljana. • Luc, M., Somorowska, U., Szmanda, J. B. (eds.) 2015: Landscape analysis and planning. Heidelberg. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-319-13527-4 • Nared, J., Razpotnik Viskovic, N. (eds.) 2014: Managing cultural heritage sites in Southeastern Europe. Ljubljana. 3.3 Citing parts of books or proceedings • Gams, I. 1987: A contribution to the knowledge of the pattern of walls in the Mediterranean karst: a case study on the N. island Hvar, Yugoslavia. Karst and man, Proceedings of the International Symposium on Human Influence in Karst. Ljubljana. • Hrvatin, M., Perko, D., Komac, B., Zorn, M. 2006: Slovenia. Soil Erosion in Europe. Chichester. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1002/0470859202.ch25 • Komac, B., Zorn, M. 2010: Statistično modeliranje plazovitosti v državnem merilu. Od razumevanja do upravljanja, Naravne nesreče 1. Ljubljana. • Zorn, M., Komac, B. 2013: Land degradation. Encyclopedia of Natural Hazards. Dordrecht. DOI: https://doi.org/10.1007/978-1-4020-4399-4_207 3.4 Citing expert reports, theses, and dissertations • Breg Valjavec, M. 2012: Geoinformatic methods for the detection of former waste disposal sites in karstic and nonkarstic regions (case study of dolines and gravel pits). Ph.D. thesis, University of Nova Gorica. Nova Gorica. • Holmes, R. L., Adams, R. K., Fritts, H. C. 1986: Tree-ring chronologies of North America: California, Eastern Oregon and Northern Great Basin with procedures used in the chronology development work including user manual for computer program COFECHA and ARSTAN. Chronology Series 6. University of Arizona, Laboratory of tree-ring research. Tucson. • Hrvatin, M. 2016: Morfometrične značilnosti površja na različnih kamninah v Sloveniji. Ph.D. thesis, Univerza na Primorskem. Koper. • Šifrer, M. 1997: Površje v Sloveniji. Elaborat, Geografski inštitut Antona Melika ZRC SAZU. Ljubljana. 3.5 Citing online material with authors and titles • Bender, O., Borsdorf, A., Heinrich, K. 2010: The interactive alpine information system GALPIS. Challenges for mountain regions, Tackling complexity. Internet: http://www.mountainresearch.at/images/Publikationen/ Sonderband/bender-borsdorf-heinrich.pdf (4.8.2014). 3.6 Citing online material without authors • Internet: http://giam.zrc-sazu.si (18.11.2016). • Internet 1: http://giam.zrc-sazu.si/ (22. 7.2012). • Internet 2: http://ags.zrc-sazu.si (23.7.2012). 180 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 3.7 Citing sources without authors • Popis prebivalstva, gospodinjstev, stanovanj in kmečkih gospodarstev v Republiki Sloveniji, 1991 - končni podatki. Zavod Republike Slovenije za statistiko. Ljubljana, 1993. • WCED - World commission on environmental and development: Our common future - Brundtland report. Oxford, 1987. 3.8 Citing cartographic sources • Buser, S. 1986: Osnovna geološka karta SFRJ 1: 100.000, list Tolmin in Videm (Udine). Savezni geološki zavod. Beograd. • Digitalni model višin 12,5. Geodetska uprava Republike Slovenije. Ljubljana, 2005. • Državna topografska karta Republike Slovenije 1: 25.000, list Brežice. Geodetska uprava Republike Slovenije. Ljubljana, 1998. • Franciscejski kataster za Kranjsko, k. o. Sv. Agata, list A02. Arhiv Republike Slovenije. Ljubljana, 1823-1869. • The vegetation map of forest communities of Slovenia 1: 400,000. Biološki inštitut Jovana Hadžija ZRC SAZU. Ljubljana, 2002. 3.9 Citing official gazettes • 1999/847/EC: Council Decision of 9 December 1999 establishing a Community action programme in the field of civil protection. Official Journal 327, 21.12.1999. • Zakon o kmetijskih zemljiščih. Uradni list Republike Slovenije 59/1996. Ljubljana. • Zakon o varstvu pred naravnimi in drugimi nesrečami. Uradni list Republike Slovenije 64/1994, 33/2000, 87/2001, 41/2004, 28/2006 in 51/2006. Ljubljana. 3.10 In-text citations Please ensure that every reference cited in the text is also in the reference list (and vice versa). In-text citations should state the last name of the author(s) and the year, separate individual citations with semicolons, order the quotes according to year, and separate the page information from the name of the author(s) and year information with a comma; for example: (Melik 1955), (Melik, Ilešič and Vrišer 1963; Kokole 1974, 7-8; Gams 1982a; Gams 1982b). For sources with more than three authors, list only the first followed by et al.: (Melik et al. 1956). Cite page numbers only for direct citations: Perko (2016, 25) states: »Hotspots are ...« To cite online material with authors, cite the name: (Zorn 2010). To cite online material without authors, cite only Internet followed by a number: (Internet 2). 3.11 Works cited list Arrange references alphabetically and then chronologically if necessary. Identify more than one reference by the same author(s) in the same year with the letters a, b, c, etc., after the year of publication: (1999a, 1999b). Use this format for indirect citations: (Gunn 2002, cited in Matei et al. 2014). Include the Digital Object Identifier (DOI) in the reference if available. Format the DOI as follows: https://doi.org/. (for example: https://doi.org/10.3986/AGS.1812). 4 Tables and figures Number all tables in the paper uniformly with their own titles. The number and the text are separated by a colon, and the caption ends with a period. Example: Table 1: Number of inhabitants of Ljubljana. Table 2: Changes in average air temperature in Ljubljana (Velkavrh 2009). 181 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Tables should contain no formatting and should not be too large; it is recommended that tables not exceed one page. Upload figures to the OJS as separate supplementary files in digital form. If the graphic supplements prepared cannot be uploaded using these programs, consult the editorial board in advance. Number all figures (maps, graphs, photographs) in the paper uniformly with their own titles. Example: Figure 1: Location of measurement points along the glacier. All graphic materials must be adapted to the journal's format. Illustrations should be exactly 134 mm wide (one page) or 64 mm wide (half page, one column), and the height limit is 200 mm. To make anonymous peer review possible, include the name of the author(s) with the title of the illustration in the supplementary file metadata, but not in the paper text. Maps should be made in digital vector form with Corel Draw, Adobe Illustrator, or a similar program, especially if they contain text. They can exceptionally be produced in digital raster form with at least 300 dpi resolution, preferably in TIFF or JPG format. For maps made with CorelDraw or Adobe Illustrator, two separate files should be prepared; the original file (.cdr or .ai format) and an image file (.jpg format). For maps made with ArcGIS with raster layers used next to vector layers (e.g., .tif of relief, airborne or satellite image), three files should be submitted: the first with a vector image without transparency together with a legend and colophon (export in .ai format), the second with a raster background (export in .tif format), and the third with all of the content (vector and raster elements) together showing the final version of the map (export in .jpg format). Do not print titles on maps; they should appear in a caption. Save colors in CMYK, not in RGB or other formats. Use Times New Roman for the legend (size 8) and colophon (size 6). List the author(s), scale, source, and copyright in the colophon. Write the colophon in English (and Slovenian, if applicable). Example: Scale: 1: 1,000,000 Content by: Drago Perko Map by: Jerneja Fridl Source: Statistical Office of the Republic of Slovenia, 2002 © 2005, ZRC SAZU Anton Melik Geographical Institute Graphs should be made in digital form using Excel on separate sheets and accompanied by data. Photos must be in raster format with a resolution of 240 dots per cm or 600 dpi, preferably in .tif or .jpg formats; that is, about 3,200 dots per page width of the journal. Figures containing a screenshot should be prepared at the highest possible screen resolution (Control Panel\All Control Panel Items\Display\Screen Resolution). The figure is made using Print Screen, and the captured screen is pasted to the selected graphic program (e.g., Parnt) and saved as .tif. The size ofthe image or its resolution must not be changed. Examples of appropriate graphic data forms: see the templates of maps in cdr and mxd files for a whole-page map in landscape view and an example of correct file structure for submitting a map made with ESRI ArcGIS. SUBMISSION PREPARATION CHECKLIST As part of the submission process, check your submission's compliance with the following items. Submissions may be returned to author(s) that do not follow these guidelines. 1. The journal policies have been reviewed. 2. The submission has not been previously published and is not being considered for publication elsewhere (or an explanation has been provided in comments to the editor). 3. The metadata (title, abstract, key words, full address, etc.) are provided in English and Slovenian, when applicable. 4. The submission is in Microsoft Word format and the document template was used (single-spaced text, 12-point font, no formatting except italics and bold). 182 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 5. The manuscript has been checked for spelling and grammar. 6. All figure locations in the text are marked. Figures are not in the text and are provided as supplementary files: cdr, .ai for maps and illustrations; .tif for photographs; xlsx for graphs. 7. Tables are placed in the text at the appropriate place. 8. The reference list was prepared following the guidelines. 9. All references in the reference list are cited in the text, and vice versa. 10. Where available, URLs and DOI numbers for references are provided. 11. Supplementary files are in one .zip file not exceeding 50 MB. 12. I agree for this article to be translated or copyedited at my expense AFTER the article is accepted for publication (see guidelines for details). 13. Permission has been obtained for the use of copyrighted material from other sources, including online sources; see the copyright notice below. 14. The instructions for ensuring a double-blind review have been followed. ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA EDITORIAL REVIEW FORM Acta geographica Slovenica editorial review form 1 The paper is an original scientific one - the paper follows the standard IMRAD scheme and is original and the first presentation of research results with the focus on methods, theoretical aspects or case study.) Yes No 2 The paper's content is suitable for publishing in the AGS journal - the paper is from the field of geography or related fields of interest, the presented topic is interesting and well presented. In case of negative answer add comments below.) Yes No 3 Editorial notes regarding the paper's content. 4 Length of the paper is acceptable for further processing (25.000 characters including space). If longer, the paper has to be shortened by the author and resubmitted. • The paper has less than 25.000 characters. • The paper has more than 25.000 characters, but less than 30.000. • The paper has more than 30.000 characters. 5 The style and formatting of the paper is according to the AGS guidelines - the paper is prepared in plain text, no other text formatting is used than bold and italic. See the Guidelines of AGS journal for details.) Yes No 6 Notes regarding style and formatting. 7 Citing in the paper is according to the AGS guidelines and style, including DOI identificators. Yes No 8 The reference list is suitable (the author cites previously published papers with similar topic from other relevant scientific journal). Yes, the author cited previously published papers on similar topic. No, the author did not cite previously published papers on similar topic. 9 Scientific language of the paper is appropriate and understandable. Yes No 183 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 10 Supplementary files (ai, cdr, pdf, tif, jpg, xlsx etc.) that were added to the paper are in proper format and resolution (including the introductory photo), maps are prepared according to the AGS Guidelines. (In this step contact the technical editor [rok.ciglic@zrc-sazu.si] for assistance if needed). • Supplementary files are correct. • Supplementary files are not appropriate and need a major correction. • Some supplementary files need corrections. 11 Describe the possible deficiencies of the supplementary files: 12 DECISION OF THE RESPONSIBLE EDITOR The paper is accepted for further processing and may be sent to the reviewer. The paper is accepted for further processing but needs technical improvements (see notes). The paper is accepted for further processing but its content needs additional improvements (see notes). The paper is not accepted for publication because: • It is more suitable for a specialized journal. • Does not fit the aims and scopes of the AGS journal. • Is not an original scientific paper. • The presentation of the results is poor. • The paper is of very low quality. • The paper has already been published elsewhere. • Other (see comments below). • Other reasons for rejection of the paper. ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA REVIEW FORM 1 RELEVANCE 1a) Are the findings original and the paper is therefore a significant one? Yes No Partly 1b) Is the paper suitable for the subject focus of the AGS journal? Yes No 2 SIGNIFICANCE 2a Does the paper discuss an important problem in geography or related fields? Yes No Partly 2b Does it bring relevant results for contemporary geography? Yes No Partly 2c What is the level of the novelty of research presented in the paper? High Middle Low 3 ORIGINALITY 3a Has the paper been already published or is too similar to work already published? Yes No 184 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 3b Does the paper discuss a new issue? Yes No 3c Are the methods presented sound and adequate? Yes No Partly 3d Do the presented data support the conclusions? Yes No Partly 4 CLARITY 4a Is the paper clear, logical and understandable? Yes No 4b If necessary, add comments and recommendations to improve the clarity of the title, abstract, keywords, introduction, methods or conclusion: 5 QUALITY 5a Is the paper technically sound? (If no, the author should discuss technical editor [rok.ciglic@zrc-sazu.si] for assistance.) Yes No 5b Does the paper take into account relevant current and past research on the topic? Yes No Propose amendments, if no is selected: 5d Is the references list the end of the paper adequate? Yes No Propose amendments, if no is selected: 5e Is the quoting in the text appropriate? Yes No Partly Propose amendments, if no is selected: 5f Which tables are not necessary? 5g Which figures are not necessary? 6 COMMENTS OF THE REVIEWER Comments of the reviewer on the contents of the paper: Comments of the reviewer on the methods used in the paper: 7 RECOMMENDATION OF THE REVIEWER TO THE EDITOR-IN-CHIEF My recommendation is: Please rate the paper from 1 [low] to 100 [high]: Personal notes of the reviewer to editor-in-chief. 185 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 COPYRIGHT NOTICE The Acta geographica Slovenica editorial board and the publisher, the ZRC SAZU Anton Melik Geographical Institute, are committed to ensuring ethics in publication and the quality of published books and journals by following the Acta Geographica Slovenica Publication Ethics and Publication Malpractice Statement. Authors must respect the copyright rules of data owners; for example, the rules of the Slovenian Surveying and Mapping Authority are available at its webpage. For paper sent to Acta geographica Slovenica, authors agree that all moral rights of the authors remain with the authors; material rights to reproduction and distribution in Slovenia and other countries are exclusively ceded to the publisher for no fee, for all time, for all cases, for unlimited editions, and for all media; and material rights to the paper figures (maps, photos, graphs, etc.) are ceded to the publisher on a non-exclusive basis. Authors allow publication of the paper or its components on the internet. Authors give permission to the publisher to modify the paper to conform to its guidelines, including the length of the paper. Authors shall provide a professional translation of papers not originally in English. The name of the translator must be reported to the editor. No honoraria are paid for papers in Acta geographica Slovenica or for the reviews. The first author of the paper shall receive one free copy of the publication. FAQ Some common questions and answers are available on the journal webpage: ags.zrc-sazu.si. PRIVACY STATEMENT The names and e-mail addresses provided to this journal site will be used exclusively for the stated purposes of this journal and will not be made available for any other purpose or to any other party. PUBLISHER Anton Melik Geographical Institute Research Center of the Slovenian Academy of Sciences and Arts PO Box 306 SI-1001 Ljubljana Slovenia SOURCES OF SUPPORT Slovenian Academy of Sciences and Arts Slovenian Research Agency JOURNAL HISTORY Acta geographica Slovenica (print version: ISSN: 1581-6613, digital version: ISSN: 1581-8314) was founded in 1952. It was originally named Geografski zbornik / Acta geographica (ISSN 0373-4498). Altogether 42 volumes were published. In 2002 Geographica Slovenica (ISSN 0351-1731, founded in 1971, 35 volumes) was merged with the journal. Since 2003 (from volume 43 onward) the name of the j oint j ournal has been Acta geographica Slovenica. The journal continues the numbering system of the journal Geografski zbornik / Acta geographica. 186 Acta geographica Slovenica, 59-2, 2019 Those interested in the history of the journal are invited to read the paper »The History of Acta geographica Slovenica in volume 50-1.« All published issues of Acta geographica Slovenica are available free of charge at http://ags.zrc-sazu.si or http://ojs.zrc-sazu.si/ags. 187 ISSN: 1581-6613 UDC - UDK: 91 ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA GEOGRAFSKI ZBORNIK 59-2 2019 © 2019, ZRC SAZU, Geografski inštitut Antona Melika Print/tisk: Tiskarna Present, d. o. o. Ljubljana 2019 ACTA GEOGRAPHICA SLOVENICA GEOGRAFSKI ZBORNIK 59-2 •2019_ Contents Drago PERKO, Rok CIGLIČ, Mauro HRVATIN The usefulness of unsupervised classification methods for landscape typification: The case of Slovenia 7 Vladimir M. CVETKOVIC, Kevin RONAN, Rajib SHAW, Marina FILIPOVIC, Rita MANO, Jasmina GAČIC, Vladimir JAKOVLJEVIC Household earthquake preparedness in Serbia: A study of selected municipalities 27 Iwona CIESLAK Spatial conflicts: Analyzing a burden created by differing land use 43 Ivan PAUNOVIC, Verka JOVANOVIC Sustainable mountain tourism in word and deed: A comparative analysis in the macro regions of the Alps and the Dinarides 59 Nikola Darko VUKSANOVIC, Dragan TEŠANOVIC, Bojana KALENJUK, Milijanko PORTIC Gender, age and education differences in food consumption within a region: Case studies of Belgrade and Novi Sad (Serbia) 71 Special issue - Franciscean cadaster as a source of studying landscape changes Matej GABROVEC, Ivan BIČiK, Blaž KOMAC Land registers as a source of studying long-term land-use changes 83 Ivan BIČiK, Matej GABROVEC, Lucie KUPKOVA Long-term land-use changes: A comparison between Czechia and Slovenia 91 Lucie KUPKOVA, Ivan BIČiK, Zdenek BOUDNY Long-term land-use / land-cover changes in Czech border regions 107 Drago KLADNIK, Matjaž GERŠIČ, Primož PIPAN, Manca VOLK BAHUN Land-use changes in Slovenian terraced landscapes 119 Daniela RIBEIRO, Mateja ŠMID HRIBAR Assessment of land-use changes and their impacts on ecosystem services in two Slovenian rural landscapes 143 Mojca FOŠKI, Alma ZAVODNIK LAMOVŠEK Monitoring land-use change using selected indices 161 ISSN 1581-6613 9 9771581661010